User Manual Tosiba 32 - 39L3300
User Manual Tosiba 32 - 39L3300
User Manual Tosiba 32 - 39L3300
LED TV
Owner's Record
You will find the model number and serial number on
the back of the TV. Record these numbers in the spaces
32L3300 Series
provided below. Refer to them whenever you call upon
your TOSHIBA dealer regarding this product.
39L3300 Series
Model number:
Serial number:
Contents
1 3
2 4
M5 × 2
M4 × 4
10) Precautions for moving the TV 5) Never pull on the power cord when removing
• When moving the TV, be sure to remove the the plug from the wall outlet.
plug from the wall outlet and disconnect the Always hold the plug firmly when removing it. If
aerial cable and audio/video cables, any steady the power cord is yanked, the cord may become
ties and mounting screw. A fire or an electric damaged and a fire or an electric shock may
shock may result if the power cord is damaged. occur.
• When carrying the TV, at least two people are 6) Never cut, break, modify, twist, bunch up
needed. Be sure to carry it upright. or bent the cord or apply excessive force or
• Never carry the TV with the screen facing up or tension to it.
down. Never place heavy objects on the cord or allow
11) Precautions for installing on outdoor aerial it to overheat as this may cause damage, a fire or
An outside aerial system should not be located an electric shock. Contact a service technician if
in the vicinity of overhead power lines, or other the power cord is damaged.
electric light or power circuits. 7) If there is thunder or lightning, never touch
If the aerial falls down or drops, it may cause an the aerial cable or other connected cables.
injury or an electric shock. You may suffer an electric shock.
Use Service
1) Never place hot objects or open flame sources, 1) Never repair, modify or disassemble the TV by
such as lighted candles or nightlights, on or yourself.
close to the TV. It may cause a fire or an electric shock.
High temperatures can melt plastic and lead to Consult a service technician for inspection and
fires. repairs.
2) The apparatus shall not be exposed to 2) When a malfunction occurs, or if smoke or
dripping or splashing and that no objects an unusual odor comes from the TV, turn off
filled with liquids, such as vases, shall be the TV and remove the power plug from the
placed on the apparatus. outlet immediately.
When liquids are spilled or small items are Make sure that the smoke or smell has stopped,
dropped inside the TV, this may cause a fire or an then contact a service technician. If the TV is still
electric shock. used in this condition, it may cause a fire or an
If small objects drop inside the TV, turn off the electric shock.
TV and remove the power plug from the outlet
immediately and contact a service technician. 3) If the TV is dropped or the cabinet is broken,
turn off the TV and remove the power plug
3) Never insert objects (metal or paper) or pour from the outlet immediately.
water inside the TV through ventilation holes If the TV has power in this condition, it may cause
and other openings. a fire or an electric shock. If the cabinet is broken,
These items may cause a fire or an electric shock. be careful when handling the TV to prevent an
If these objects are inserted inside the TV, turn injury.
off the TV and remove the power plug from Contact a service technician for inspection and
the outlet immediately and contact a service repair.
technician. Be especially careful that children do
not insert objects in the TV. 4) When the TV reaches the end of its useful life,
ask a qualified service technician to properly
4) When the TV will not be used for a long period dispose of the TV.
of time, such as during vacation or travel,
remove the power plug from the wall outlet
for safety.
• The TV is not completely disconnected from
the power supply line, as minute current is
consumed even when the 1 Power switch is
turned off.
• The Mains plug or an appliance coupler is
used as the disconnect device, therefore
the disconnect device shall remain readily
operable.
Exemptions
• Toshiba is not liable for any damage caused
by fires, natural disaster (such as thunder,
earthquake, etc.), acts by third parties, accidents,
owner’s misuse, or uses in other improper
conditions.
• Toshiba is not liable for incidental damages
(such as profit loss or interruption in business,
modification or erasure of record data, etc.)
caused by use or inability to use of product.
• Toshiba is not liable for any damage caused
by neglect of the instructions described in the
owner’s manual.
• Toshiba is not liable for any damage caused by
misuse or malfunction through simultaneous use
of this product and the connected equipment.
IN
OUT
Cautions:
• Dispose of batteries in a designated disposal area.
Batteries must not be exposed to excessive heat such
as sunshine, fire or the like.
Aerial cable • Attention should be drawn to the environmental
(75 7 coaxial) (not supplied) aspects of battery disposal.
300 7 twin-lead feeder • Never mix battery types or combine used batteries
with new ones.
Aerial adaptor NOTE:
75 7
(not supplied) aerial • If the remote control does not operate correctly, or if
terminal the operating range becomes reduced, replace both
75 7 coaxial cable batteries with new ones.
• If the batteries are dead or if you will not use the
remote control for a long time, remove the batteries
Plug 75 7 aerial to prevent battery acid from leaking into the battery
(not supplied) terminal compartment.
Effective range
within 5 m
Cable holder*
1 7 8
Left side view LAN
2 (2)
15
VIDEO
VIDEO
PC/HDMI 1 Y
(AUDIO)
3 L/
PB/CB MONO
9
14 AUDIO
4
PR/CR
RGB/PC
R
L/
MONO
DIGITAL
AUDIO AUDIO
10
5 R
COMPONENT/
AUDIO(FIXED)
VIDEO INPUT
(1)
6 13 12 11
Cable holder *
* You can use the cable holder to hold the aerial
1 ! (power LED) — Power indicator cable, video and audio cables etc.
(- page 11). Never grasp the holder when moving the TV.
2 ! (power on/standby) — Press to turn the TV
on/ standby (- page 11). 7 A (aerial input terminal) — Analogue aerial
3 2 – + (volume) — These buttons adjust the signal input (- page 8).
volume level. 8 LAN port — For use when connecting to
U u (mode up/down) — These buttons select network (- page 33).
programme position or input source. 9 o (2) (video 2 input terminals) — Standard
4 p / o (programme position or input source) video and standard stereo audio input. (-
— When external input list is displayed, an page 29).
input source can be selected. 10 O AUDIO (output terminals) — Standard
5 USB 1-2 (input terminals) — Insert your USB audio outputs (FIXED) (- page 29).
storage device (photo, movie and music) 11 o (1) COMPONENT / VIDEO INPUT (input
(- page 41). terminals) — High-definition component video
• Connect a USB HDD to the USB 2 port. and standard (analogue) stereo audio inputs, or
• The USB port also has to be used with the standard (composite) video and standard stereo
“TOSHIBA Dual Band WLAN Adaptor” (WLM- audio inputs (- page 29).
40U : not supplied) in order to access a wireless
network. (- page 34).
1 1 Power on/Standby
2 2 Input source selection (TV, VIDEO or
5 COMPONENT, HDMI, PC)
3
4 6 3 Picture Mode
4 Picture Size
5 Sound Mode
6 Stereo/Bilingual selection
7 7 Number buttons (0-9)
8 To return to the previous programme
9 To display the Channel List
10 Volume – + (These buttons adjust the volume
level.)
8 9
11 • To display on-screen information
11 • Initial/Index function for Teletext
12 Sound Mute (This button turns the sound off/
10 14 on.)
13 Teletext on/Superimpose Teletext/off
14 Programme position U u
13 12
15 To access the Menu
15 16 16 To access the Quick Menu
17 17 • Menu
• OK
18 To return to the previous menu
18 19 19 EXIT
20 20 Teletext control buttons (Four coloured buttons:
22 Red, Green, Yellow, Blue)
21 21 Subtitle on/off
23 22 Picture still
23 When using the Media Player (
z Z)
When using the Teletext ( )
10
• The TV will automatically turn off in 15 minutes To use the TV for displaying in a store showroom, please select
based on No Signal Power Down settings (- [Store]. [Home] mode is recommended for normal use.
No
Yes
11
• When using the wired LAN, connect the LAN Easy Setup using PIN (Personal
cable (- page 33). Identification Number) (- page 35)
• When using the wireless LAN, connect the 1 Press or to select PIN.
TOSHIBA Dual Band WLAN Adapter (WLM-40U
: not supplied) to the USB port (- page 34) 2 Press to select Start Scan and press
• When you select No, skip to step 9. OK.
3 Press or to select the desired AP
6 Press OK to display the Network Type menu. and press OK.
Press or to select Wired or Wireless.
Note:
Network Type Check the Network Name and/or MAC
address on the label of the AP or in the
Please select a network type. manual, and select your AP.
4 When the PIN code window appears,
Wired
enter the displayed PIN into your AP,
and then press Next to continue the
PIN Setup. When a message displays to
NOTE:
report that the setup is complete, press
If the TOSHIBA Dual Band WLAN Adaptor is not
OK.
connected, Network Type screen does not display
and skip to step 7. Assisted Setup (- page 36)
When Wired is selected: 1 Press or to select the desired AP
and press OK.
Press OK to display the Advanced Network
Setup menu. Note:
Go to step 7. Check the MAC address on the label of the
AP or in the manual, and select your AP.
When Wireless is selected: 2 Press or to select Security Key and
Press OK to display the Wireless Setup menu. press OK.
The Software Keyboard window will
Wireless Setup appear.
Please select a kind of wireless network. 3 Input the Security Key by using the
Software Keyboard (- page 39).
Easy Setup To save your setting, press the BLUE
button.
From the Wireless Setup menu, press or NOTE:
to select Easy Setup, Assisted Setup or • The Security Key must adhere to these
Manual Setup, and press OK. conditions:
- AES, TKIP/AES: 8-63 ASCII or 64 Hex
Easy Setup using PBC (Push Button characters
Configuration) (- page 35) - WEP: 5 or 13 ASCII or 10 or 26 Hex
1 Press or to select PBC. characters
• There is only one key ID to set for WEP
2 Press to highlight Start Scan and
encryption.
press OK.
4 Highlight Done and press OK.
3 Following the on-screen instructions,
push the appropriate button on your AP. NOTE:
If Network Name is not displayed, see
4 When a window reporting that the setup
step 4 and 5 in Manual Setup below to set
is complete appears, press OK.
Network Name before pressing Done.
12
Manual Setup (- page 36) 7 From Advanced Network Setup menu, set
1 Press or to select Network Name Auto Setup to On or Off , and press to select
and press OK. Next.
The Software Keyboard window will When the DHCP function of the router
appear. connected with this TV is On, you can set Auto
2 Input the Network Name by using the Setup to On or Off. (This should usually be set
Software Keyboard (- page 39). to On.)
To save your setting, press the BLUE Advanced Network Setup
button. IP Address Setup
NOTE:
MAC Address 00. 11. 22. 33. 44. 55
• Certain encryption types are only
compatible with specific authentication Next
types.
- When Authentication is Open System, When the DHCP function of the router is Off, set
WEP or None is compatible. Auto Setup to Off, and set the IP Address DNS
- When Authentication is Shared Key, address(es) manually.
WEP or None is compatible.
- When Authentication is WPA2/WPA- 8 Press OK, and Network Connection Test will
PSK, AES or AES/TKIP is compatible. start.
- When Authentication is WPA2-PSK,
only AES is compatible. A message will appear to indicate if the
• There is only one key ID to set for WEP connection was successful or it could not be
encryption. completed.
5 Press or to select Security Key and NOTE:
press OK. The result of Network Connection Test does not
always guarantee the connection.
6 Input the Security Key by using the
Software Keyboard (- page 39). 9 Press OK to display the Auto Tuning menu, and
To save your setting, press the BLUE then or to select On or Off.
button. Auto Tuning
13
14
PICTURE
Picture Settings
3D Colour Management
Base Colour Adjustment
Off
PREFERENCES
Active Backlight Control On
PREFERENCES
Network Setup
Teletext Auto
Teletext Language 1
Panel Lock Off
Display Settings
SOUND AV Connection
Energy Saving Settings
Blue Screen On
SOUND
MTS Auto
Dual Dual 1
Balance 0 SETUP
Advanced Sound Settings
Audio Distortion Control On
Dynamic Range Control Off SETUP
Audio Level Offset 0 Menu Language English
SETUP
Spectrum Analyser Auto Tuning
Menu Language English
Manual Tuning
Auto Tuning
Quick Setup
Manual Tuning
Location Home
APPLICATIONS Quick Setup
Software Upgrade
Location Home
Software Licences
Software Licences
System Information
System Information
APPLICATIONS Reset TV
Media Player
YouTube
On Timer
Sleep Timer 00:00
NOTE:
• In the video input mode ( o1, o2 and HDMI), Auto Tuning, Manual Tuning and Quick Setup are not
available.
• If you do not make a selection for a while, the menu display disappears automatically.
• If you want to close the menu display instantly, press EXIT or MENU.
• To return to the previous menu, press BACK.
• In the PC input mode, PC Settings is available in the Display Settings menu (- page 32).
• When you use the colour management function (- page 20), you can select the Base Colour Adjustment
menu.
• When a "TOSHIBA Dual Band WLAN Adaptor" (WLM-40U : not supplied) is connected, Screen Mirroring
appears in the APPLICATIONS menu (- page 40).
15
16
1 Select the first position you want to view. 1 From the SETUP menu, press or to select
Manual Tuning menu, and then press OK.
2 Select the second position with the Number
buttons (0-9). 2 Press or to select the channel ABCD, then
press .
3 Press . The previous channel will be displayed.
Manual Tuning
Each time you press , the TV will switch back Pos. Label
and forth between the two positions. 0
1 ABCD
Displaying the on-screen information
2 EFGH
5
4 ABCD Stereo 6
17
Dot by Dot
“Dot by Dot” is a non-scaling display. Depending on
4:3 the input signal format, the picture is displayed with
Use this setting to view a true 4:3 broadcast. side panels and/or bars at the top and bottom (e.g.
VGA input source).
Super Live
This setting will enlarge a 4:3 image to fit the screen
by stretching the image horizontally and vertically, Normal
holding better proportions at the centre of the Sets the size to full screen without changing the
image. Some distortion may occur. aspect ratio when watching a movie stored on a USB
device.
Native
This setting will display the image correctly without Zoom
distortion or picture clipping. Sets the size to full screen keeping the 21:9
circularity ratio when watching a movie stored on a
USB device.
18
width ratio) for the purpose of public display or Picture Mode Standard
commercial gain may infringe on copyright laws. Backlight 70
Contrast 95
• If the aspect ratio of the selected format is different Brightness 50
from the one of the TV transmission or video Colour 50
19
Using the Cinema Mode 2 Select Auto Clean 2, and then press or to
select On or Off.
This feature will reduce picture blur without Off mode :
decreasing image brightness or adding flicker. MPEG NR menu and DNR menu are available.
1 From the Picture Settings menu, press or • MPEG NR mode: Low, Middle, High or Off
to select Cinema Mode. • DNR (Digital Noise Reduction) mode: Low,
Middle, High or Off
2 Press or to select On or Off.
Resetting the Picture Settings
Adjusting the Colour Temperature
This feature resets the Picture Settings to the
Colour Temperature increases the warmth or factory settings.
coolness of the picture by setting the red, green or NOTE:
blue tint. If no picture settings have been changed, Reset is not
1 From the Picture Settings menu, press or available.
to select Colour Temperature, then press OK. 1 From the Picture Settings menu, press or
2 Press or to select Cool, Natural, or Warm to select Reset, and then press OK.
to suit your preference. 2 A confirmation message will appear. Press or
Colour Temperature
to select Yes, and then press OK.
Colour Temperature Cool Adjusting the Colour Management
Red Level 0
Green Level 0
You can adjust the picture colour quality by
Blue Level 0
Reset selecting from 6 base colour adjustments : Red,
Green, Blue, Yellow, Magenta or Cyan.
20
SOUND
21
Sound to be heard
Display
3 Press or to select Dynamic, Natural or
German stereo/ Clear Voice.
NICAM
bilingual broadcast
j Dual 1 Sub I sound Main sound Adjusting the sound quality
J Dual 2 Sub II sound Sub sound You can adjust the basic sound quality.
e Mono Main sound — 1 From the Advanced Sound Settings menu,
press or to select Bass or Treble.
NOTE:
These settings are not stored in the TV memory. 2 Press or to adjust the settings as desired.
22
23
On Timer
3 Press EXIT to start the timer.
Enable On Timer On
Input TV
To cancel the Sleep Timer, enter all zeros for the
Position 1 step 2.
Volume 30
Time Until Power On 00:10 Using the Auto Format
Done When the TV receives a true HDMI signal picture
and the Auto Format is On, it will automatically be
displayed in HDMI signal format, irrespective of the
3 Press or to go through the list adding the TV’s previous setting.
details of the on timer by using the Number
buttons and or to make selections and 1 From the Display Settings in the
press OK. PREFERENCES menu, press or to select
Auto Format.
Input: Select a video input source (TV, EXT 1,
EXT 2, HDMI 1, HDMI 2 or PC). Display Settings
24
NOTE: NOTE:
This feature is not available when Auto Format is set • Default setting is all On.
to Off. • A warning message will appear 1 minute before
turning off.
Panel Lock
Viewing the Software Licences
Panel Lock disables the buttons on the TV. All
buttons on the remote control can still be used. The licences for the software used in this TV are
available for viewing on screen.
1 From the PREFERENCES menu, press or to
select Panel Lock. 1 From the SETUP menu, press or to select
Software Licences.
2 Press or to select On or Off.
NOTE: 2 Press OK.
When Panel Lock is On, a reminder will appear when A screen will appear displaying all of the
the keys on the TV are touched. If the standby key is licencing information required for the TV’s
touched, the TV will switch off and can only be brought software.
out of standby by using the remote control.
Confirming software version
Setting the Automatic Power Down
The TV will automatically turn itself off (standby) 1 From the SETUP menu, press or to select
after approximately 4 hours, if you do not operate System Information and then press OK.
the control buttons on the remote control or on the 2 Press OK to display the software version.
TV control panel.
NOTE:
1 From the PREFERENCES menu, press or The software version displayed is just for the
until Energy Saving Settings is selected, and illustration.
then press OK.
Resetting the TV
2 Press or to select Automatic Power
Down, press or to select On or Off, and Reset TV will reset all TV settings, including stored
then press EXIT. channels, to their original factory values.
NOTE: 1 From the SETUP menu, press or to select
1 minute before switching to standby, a warning Reset TV.
message will appear.
25
Selecting the external input source to view Labelling video input sources
1 Press o on the remote control until the These input labels are shown in the input selector.
external input mode list appears on the screen, You can label external inputs according to the
then press , or o to select appropriate devices you have connected to the TV.
input source (or press p / o and U or u on 1 From the PREFERENCES menu, press or
the TV left side panel to select required input to select AV Connection and press OK.
source directly).
2 Press or to select Input Labelling and
Inputs press OK.
TV
VIDEO1 Input Labelling
VIDEO2 Input Label
HDMI 1 EXT 1 --
HDMI 2 EXT 2 --
PC HDMI 1 --
HDMI 2 --
PC --
2 Press OK.
VIDEO1 (o (1), COMPONENT/VIDEO INPUT, 3 Press or to select the item you want to
standard or component video input) , label and press or to select --, Amplifier,
VIDEO2 (o (2), standard video input), Cable, DVD, Game, PC, Recorder, Satellite or
HDMI1, HDMI2 (HDMI input), VCR, or press the RED button to turn on the
PC (o RGB/PC, PC input) skip.
4 Repeat step 3 for other video inputs.
Setting the Colour System
This feature is available in Standard video Channel List
(composite) inputs mode.
1 Press LIST. The Channel List will appear.
1 Press MENU, and then press or to display
Channel List
the SETUP menu.
1
2
3
4
SETUP
Menu Language English 5
Auto Tuning 6
Manual Tuning 7
Colour System Auto 8
Quick Setup
Location Home
Software Upgrade
Software Licences
2 Press or to select a channel, and then
press OK.
26
Teletext Sub-pages:
This TV has a multi-page Teletext memory, which Once in this chosen page, if there are sub-pages
takes a few moments to load and it offers two they will automatically load into memory without
ways of viewing Teletext Auto and List which are changing the one you are reading. If there are many
explained below. sub-pages, it will take a long time for them all to
load and this will depend on the speed with which
Setting up the Teletext mode the broadcaster transmits them.
To access the sub-pages in memory, press or
To select a language for Teletext: to view them.
The language 1-4 option enables the display of
different language when using Teletext.
Using Subtitles
1 From the PREFERENCES menu, and then press 1 Press SUBTITLE on the remote control to while
or to select Teletext Language. the teletext screen is displayed to display
subtitles. While the subtitles are displayed, press
2 Press or to select the required language. SUBTITLE again to change the setting.
• Language 1: English, German, Dutch,
Flemish, Russian, Bulgarian, Ukranian, Lettish,
Using Auto mode
Lithuanian, Czech, Slovak, Estonian There are two Modes: Auto will display FASTEXT, if
• Language 2: Polish, German, Dutch, Flemish, available. List will display your four favorite pages.
Estonian, Lettish, Lithuanian, French, Serbian, In either mode, as an alternative to the coloured
Croatian, Slovenian, Czech, Slovak, Rumanian buttons, you can access a page by entering a 3-digit
• Language 3: English, French, Hebrew, Turkish, number, using the Number buttons on the remote
Arabic control, or to advance to the next page, press PU, to
• Language 4: English, French, Hebrew, Turkish, go back to the previous page press Pu. To change
Farsi (Iranian/Persian) between Auto and List, see above.
To select Teletext mode: • Press TEXT to access teletext.
Select a channel position with the desired Teletext 100 Spor t 14:57:55
service.
1 From PREFERENCES menu, press or to
select Teletext.
2 Press or to select Auto or List mode. Football Baseball Racing Swimming
27
28
(with component L/
• Connect the DIGITAL AUDIO output terminal to the
video outputs)
PB/CB MONO
OPTICAL input of a receiver or processor.
or PR/CR AUDIO • Refer to the owner’s manual of the connected
L/
MONO
R equipment as well.
• When you connect the TV to other equipment, be
AUDIO
Audio system sure to turn off the power and unplug all of the
R
COMPONENT/
equipment from the wall outlet before making any
VIDEO INPUT AUDIO(FIXED)
(1)
connections.
Set Top Box • The output sound of the TV has a wide dynamic
or range. Be sure to adjust the audio amplifier’s volume
to a moderate listening level before turning on the
power. Otherwise, the speakers and your hearing
VCR (Normal)
may be damaged by sudden high volume audio.
• Turn off the amplifier before you connect or
• Before connecting any external equipment, turn disconnect the TV’s power cord. If you leave the
off all main power switches. amplifier power on, the speakers may be damaged.
• The unauthorized recording of TV programmes, Warning:
DVDs, video tapes and other materials may When you are connecting (via the DIGITAL AUDIO
infringe upon the provisions of copyright law. output terminal) an AV decoder that does not have
• The COMPONENT VIDEO INPUT consists of three Dolby Digital decoding function, be sure to set PCM
component video signals (Y, PB/CB, PR/CR) and for Digital Audio Output menu (- page 23).
provides the best picture performance. These Otherwise, the speakers and your hearing may be
terminals can only be used with the component damaged by sudden high volume audio.
video compatible equipment e.g. DVD video
player, etc. Connecting an amplifier equipped with a Dolby Digital
• If you connect to COMPONENT VIDEO for the decoder
COMPONENT / VIDEO INPUT terminals, screen
display will appear changes to COMPONENT.
• Additional equipment and cables shown are not Amplifier equipped with
Dolby Digital decoder
supplied with this TV.
NOTE: To Optical type
o (1) COMPONENT / VIDEO INPUT terminals digital audio input
Optical digital cable
Standard mode Component mode (not supplied)
VIDEO VIDEO
Y Y
Green
To Digital Audio
Yellow
PB/CB PB/CB DIGITAL output terminal
AUDIO
Blue TV back view
PR/CR PR/CR
Red
L/ L/
MONO MONO
White White
AUDIO AUDIO Front speaker Surround speaker Sub woofer
Red Red Centre speaker Signal flow
R R (Audio)
COMPONENT/ COMPONENT/
VIDEO INPUT VIDEO INPUT
(1) (1)
You can enjoy dynamic realistic sound by
connecting the TV to an amplifier equipped with a
Dolby Digital decoder or Dolby Digital processor.
When using this setup, select Auto in the Digital
Audio Output menu (- page 23).
29
Connecting an amplifier equipped with a digital audio • HDMI: High-Definition Multimedia Interface
(optical) input • HDCP: High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection
• CEA-861-D compliance covers the transmission of
uncompressed digital video with high-bandwidth
Amplifier equipped with digital content protection, which is being
digital audio input
standardized for reception of high-definition
To Optical type video signals. Because this is an evolving
digital audio input technology, it is possible that some devices may
not operate properly with the TV.
Optical digital cable • Acceptable PC signal format:
(not supplied)
• S-VGA: VESA 800 5 600 @ 56/60/72/75 Hz
To Digital Audio • XGA: VESA 1024 5 768 @ 60/70/75 Hz
DIGITAL
AUDIO output terminal • W-XGA: VESA 1280 5 768 @ 60/75 Hz
TV back view • W-XGA: VESA 1360 5 768 @ 60 Hz
• S-XGA: VESA 1280 5 1024 @ 60 Hz
However, these signal formats are converted to
Front speaker Signal flow match the number of pixels of the LCD panel.
Therefore, the TV may not display small text
You can enjoy the dynamic sound of a 2-channel properly.
digital stereo by connecting the TV to an amplifier If you connect this unit to your PC, the compressed
equipped with a digital audio (optical) input and image is displayed in S-XGA mode, therefore the
speaker system (right and left front speakers). When picture quality may deteriorate and characters may
using this setup, select PCM in the Digital Audio not be read.
Output menu (- page 23). • L-PCM: Linear-Pulse Code Modulation
• Supported Audio format: L-PCM, Dolby Digital
Connecting HDMI or DVI devices sample rate 32/44,1/48 kHz
• When turning on your electronic components,
turn on the TV first, and then the HDMI and DVI
Connecting an HDMI device
device. One HDMI cable (type A connector)
• When turning off your electronic components, For proper operation, it is recommended that you
turn off the HDMI and DVI device first, and then use a short HDMI cable.
the TV. HDMI cable transfers both video and audio.
• This TV may not be compatible with features and/
or specifications that may be added in the future. TV side view
• This TV is only operable with L-PCM and Dolby
Digital on 32/44.1/48 kHz. If there is no sound TV back view
when using HDMI, use the analogue audio cables
to connect the TV and the HDMI device, and
select Analogue in HDMI 1 Audio of the AV
Connection menu (- page 31).
• This TV is able to connect with HDMI devices. But
it is possible that some HDMI devices may not
operate properly with this TV. HDMI device
Connecting HDMI or DVI devices VIDE O
L
AUDIO
R
IN
HD MI OU T
The HDMI input on your TV receives digital audio OUT
Connecting a computer
To connect a PC to the RGB/PC terminal on the TV:
An analogue RGB (15 pin) computer cable can be
connected.
TV back view
PC/HDMI 1
(AUDIO)
DVI device
VIDEO AUDIO DVI
L R OUT
RGB/PC
IN
OUT
Audio cable
for PC-to-TV
connection
Input Labelling
Connect a PC cable from the computer to the
PC/HDMI 1 Audio PC o RGB/PC terminal on the back of the TV.
HDMI 1 Audio Digital
Digital Audio Output Auto The following signals can be displayed:
VGA: VESA 640 x 480 @ 60/72/75 Hz
S-VGA: VESA 800 x 600 @ 56/60/72/75 Hz
3 Press or to select PC/HDMI 1 Audio and
XGA: VESA 1024 x 768 @ 60/70/75 Hz
press or to select PC or HDMI1.
W-XGA: VESA 1280 x 768 @ 60/75 Hz
W-XGA: 1280 x 800 @ 60/75 Hz
W-XGA: VESA 1360 x 768 @ 60 Hz
W-XGA+: 1440 x 900 @ 60 Hz
S-XGA: VESA 1280 x 1024 @ 60 Hz
1920 x 1080p @ 60 Hz (Horizontal Frequency: 67.5
kHz (H), Pixel Clock Frequency: 148.5 MHz)
31
32
33
34
7 When the PIN code window appears, enter the Manual Setup
displayed PIN into your AP, and then press Next
to continue the PIN Setup. When a message 1 From the PREFERENCES menu, select Network
displays to report that the setup is complete, Setup and press OK.
press OK.
2 Press or to select Wireless Setup and
To cancel searching for the AP: press OK.
Press BACK while searching for the AP. A message
will appear; then, press or to select Yes and 3 Press or to select Manual Setup and press
press OK. OK.
36
AP MAC The AP’s MAC address is 1 From the PREFERENCES menu, select Network
Address displayed when the TV is Setup and press OK.
connected with the AP. 2 Press or to select Advanced Network
TV MAC The MAC address of the USB Setup, and press OK.
Address (Dual Band WLAN Adaptor) is 3 Press or to select IP Address Setup, and
displayed. press OK.
DHCP Enabled is displayed when 4 Select Auto Setup, and then press or to
using DHCP. select On.
Disabled is displayed when not
using DHCP. IP Address Setup
37
38
39
APPLICATIONS
Media Player APPLICATIONS
YouTube Media Player
On Timer YouTube
2 Press or to select YouTube, and then press • Alternatively, press QUICK to display the
OK. Quick Menu, and select it.
The YouTube homepage appears. NOTE:
If the Dual Band WLAN Adaptor (WLM-40U : not
• You can select YouTube from the Quick Menu. supplied) is not connected, Screen Mirroring is
NOTE: not displayed.
• Some features require an always-on broadband 2 Press or to select Screen Mirroring and
internet connection, firmware update and/or press OK.
additional bandwidth dedicated to this product.
Third party services may change or be discontinued The connection standby screen appears.
or restricted at any time. Toshiba makes no
warranties, representations, or assurances about 3 Operate your tablet, smartphone or PC to
the content, availability or functionality of third- display the screen on the TV.
party content or services. Use of third party services Select the TV which you wish to connect to.
may require registration by a computer and/ “Connecting” will be shown on the TV.
or payment of charges and membership. Not all • PBC mode:
services or content may be available on this product, After the Screen Mirroring connection is
in your country or with your language. In order to complete, the TV screen will mirror the
experience the full capabilities of this product, fully content shown on the tablet, smartphone or
compatible devices may be required. PC.
• This service may be forcibly blocked according to the
situation of CSP service. • PIN mode:
• This function may not behave correctly depending Proceed to step 4.
on the network environment.
4 Connecting your tablet, smartphone or PC to
your TV the first time
When selecting the Toshiba TV for the first time,
a 8-digit code will appear on your TV screen.
This code needs to be input into your tablet or
smartphone to authenticate the connection.
If authentication has already taken place,
”Connecting” will appear on screen.
• After the Screen Mirroring connection is
complete, the TV screen will mirror the
content shown on the tablet, smartphone or
PC.
40
Basic operation
Using Media Player
When Auto Start is enabled, you will be asked if
you want to start the Media Player whenever a USB
device is inserted. If Auto Start is disabled, you must
manually start the Media Player from the menu.
To change the Auto Start setting:
1 From the APPLICATIONS menu, press or
to select Media Player and press OK.
2 Press or to select Setup and press OK.
3 Press or to select Auto Start and press
or to select On or Off.
41
Manual Start:
1 Insert USB device into the USB socket on the left XXXXXXXX.jpg XXXXXXXX.jpg XXXXXXXX.jpg XXXXXXXX.jpg XXXXXXXX.jpg XXXXXXXX.jpg XXXXXXXX.jpg
42
NOTE:
Pressing or while in the Slide Show mode will XXXXXXXX.mpg XXXXXXXX.mpg XXXXXXXX.mpg XXXXXXXX.mpg
43
44
45
4 Press BACK.
SETUP
To display the file status information Menu Language English
Auto Tuning
1 Press during playback. The information will Manual Tuning
Quick Setup
be displayed on the centre of the screen.
Location Home
46
AVI .avi Video) H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC) Maximum number of files: 4096 per
DivX 3, 4, 5 folder
Xvid Maximum viewable resolution:
MJPEG 1920x1080
47
48
50
51
52
53
ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ
٢
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
ﺗﺠﻤﻴﻊ ﺣﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻋﺪﺓ
ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻪ :ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ ﺑﺘﺠﻤﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻋﺪﺓ ،ﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺔ ﺍﻻﻣﺎﻣﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ LCDﻣﺘﺠﻬﺔ ﻟﻼﺳﻔﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﺢ ﻣﻨﺒﺴﻂ ﻭﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻭﺳﺎﺩﺓ ﻣﺜﻞ ﻟﺤﺎﻑ ﺃﻭ ﺑﻄﺎﻧﻴﺔ
ﺑﺤﺬﺭ .ﺩﻉ ﺍﻟﺠﺰﺀ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﻠﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻮﺣﺪﺓ ﺑﺎﺭﺯﺍ ﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻄﺢ ﻭﻗﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﺠﻤﻴﻊ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻣﺒﻴﻦ ﺍﺩﻧﺎﻩ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻳﺠﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﻌﻨﺎﻳﺔ ﻓﺎﺋﻘﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻟﺘﺠﻨﺐ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺗﻠﻒ ﺑﺸﺎﺷﺔ .LCD
٣ ١
٤ ٢
M5 × 2
M4 × 4
ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ :ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﻋﺪﻡ ﻗﺮﺽ ﻛﺒﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﺣﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﻋﺪﺓ ﻷﻥ
ﺫﻟﻚ ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
٣
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
ﻗﻢ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ﹰ ﺑﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﻤﺄﺧﺬ ﻣﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﻟﻠﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻲ (٤ ﺗﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﻣﻬﻤﺔ ﻟﻠﺴﻼﻣﺔ
ﻣﺠﻬﺰ ٢٤٠ - ١١٠ﻓﻮﻟﺖ ،ﺗﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﺘﻨﺎﻭﺏ ٦٠/٥٠ﻫﺮﺗﺰ.
ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﻴﺪ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻨﺒﻴﻬﺎﺕ ﺍﻹﺣﺘﻴﺎﻃﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻟﻀﻤﺎﻥ
ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﺧﺎﺭﺝ ﻧﻄﺎﻕ ﻓﺮﻕ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺪ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺪﺩ؛
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺁﻣﻨﺔ.
ﻓﻘﺪ ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ .ﻗﺪ ﻳﺴﺒﺐ
ﺍﻧﺪﻻﻉ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ. ﺍﻟﺘﺮﻛﻴﺐ
ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺼﻬﺮ
ﻓﻲ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺘﺄﺭﻳﺾ ﺛﻼﺛﻲ ﺍﻟﺴﻨﻮﻥ ،ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺼﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻛﺐ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ (١ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ :ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻷﻱ ﺇﺻﺎﺑﺔ ،ﻳﺠﺐ ﺗﺜﺒﻴﺖ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻋﻠﻰ
ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﻣﻌﺘﻤ ﹰﺪﺍ ﻣﻦ ASTAﺃﻭ BSIﻟـ .BS1362ﻭﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﺒﺪﻳﻠﻪ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ/ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺈﺣﻜﺎﻡ ﺑﻤﺎ ﻳﺘﻔﻖ ﻣﻊ ﺇﺭﺷﺎﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﻛﻴﺐ.
ﺇﻻ ﺑﻨﻮﻉ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﻭﻣﺼﻨﹼﻒ ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ ،ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﺠﺐ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺗﺜﺒﻴﺖ ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺃﻓﻘﻲ ﻭﻓﻲ ﻣﻜﺎﻥ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺮ .ﻗﻢ
ﺍﻟﻐﻄﺎﺀ. ﺑﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺤﺎﻣﻞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﺴﻤﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺜﺒﻴﺖ.
ﺣﻮﻝ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ • ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻋﺪﻡ ﻧﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺈﺣﻜﺎﻡ ،ﻓﺈﻧﻪ ﻗﺪ ﻳﻤﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﻳﻘﻊ
• ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﺑﺲ ﺑﺈﺣﻜﺎﻡ ،ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺳﻠﻚ ﻃﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ،ﻭﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﺇﺣﺪﺍﺙ ﺇﺻﺎﺑﺔ.
ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺮﺩﺩ ﻓﻲ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻃﺮﻑ ﻣﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺎﻟﺤﺎﺋﻂ. • ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻷﻱ ﺇﺻﺎﺑﺔ ،ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻣﻞ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭﻱ ﺍﻟﺤﺼﺮﻱ،
• ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺴﻴﻄﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﻣﻠﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﺲ ،ﻋﻨﺪ ﻓﺼﻞ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺃﻭ ﺣﻤﺎﻟﺔ ﻣﺜﺒﺘﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ ،ﻟﺘﺜﺒﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ﺃﻭ
ﻃﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺮﺩﺩ. ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ ﺑﺈﺣﻜﺎﻡ ﺣﺴﺒﻤﺎ ﻳﺮﺍﻩ ﺍﻟﻔﻨﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﻫﻞ.
• ﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺃﻱ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺁﺧﺮ ﻣﻄﻘﹰ ﺎ ﻋﺪﺍ ﺳﻠﻚ ﻃﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺮﺩﺩ
ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻓﻖ ،ﻭﻻ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﻓﻖ ﻷﻱ ﻏﺮﺽ ﺁﺧﺮ.
ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﺪ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ ﹰ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺃﻭ ﻧﺰﻉ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﺑﻴﺪ ﻣﺒﻠﻠﺔ. (٥
ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
ﻻ ﺗﻘﻢ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﺑﺴﺪ ﺍﻟﺸﻘﻮﻕ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺪﻭﻕ (٦ (٢ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺮ ﻛﺄﻥ ﺗﻀﻌﻪ
ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻭﻱ ﻟﻠﺠﻬﺎﺯ. ﻋﻠﻰ ﻃﺎﻭﻟﺔ ﻣﻬﺘﺰﺓ ،ﺃﻭ ﻣﺎﺋﻼ ﹰ ،ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﻳﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻟﻼﻫﺘﺰﺍﺯ.
• ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﺑﺤﻴﺚ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﺟﻬﻪ ﻷﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻭ ﻋﻠﻰ • ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻓﻘﻂ ﺍﻟﺨﺰﺍﻧﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﻋﺪ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺻﻰ ﺑﻬﺎ ﻣﻦ ﺻﺎﻧﻌﻲ
ﺃﺣﺪ ﺟﺎﻧﺒﻴﻪ. ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
• ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻓﻲ ﺧﺰﺍﻧﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﻣﻜﺘﺒﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﺃﻱ ﻣﺴﺎﺣﺔ • ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺍﻷﺛﺎﺙ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﺷﺒﻴﻬﺔ ،ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻮﻳﺔ ﺭﺩﻳﺌﺔ. • ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻟﻴﺲ ﻣﻮﺿﻮﻋﹰﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺎﻓﺔ ﺍﻷﺛﺎﺙ.
ﺗﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﺑﺠﺮﻳﺪﺓ ،ﺃﻭ ﻣﻔﺮﺵ ﻣﻦ ﻗﻤﺎﺵ،ﺃﻭ • ﻻ ﱢ • ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻄﻊ ﺃﺛﺎﺙ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺔ )ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺒﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﺜﺎﻝ،
ﺳﺘﺎﺭﺓ. ﺍﻟﺪﻭﺍﻟﻴﺐ ﻭﺍﻟﻤﻜﺘﺒﺎﺕ( ﺩﻭﻥ ﺗﺜﺒﻴﺖ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻗﻄﻌﺔ ﺍﻷﺛﺎﺙ
• ﻋﻨﺪ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺃﻣﺎﻡ ﺟﺪﺍﺭ ،ﻓﺎﺣﺮﺹ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺠﻌﻞ ﺑﺤﺎﻣﻞ ﺛﺎﺑﺖ.
ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻌﺪ ١٠ﺳﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﻗﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ. • ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﻤﺎﺵ ﺃﻭ ﺃﻱ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ ﺑﻴﻦ
• ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻄﺢ ﺭﺧﻮ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺘﻘﺮ ،ﻛﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻗﻄﻌﺔ ﺍﻷﺛﺎﺙ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺿﻮﻉ ﻋﻠﻴﻬﺎ.
ﺗﻀﻌﻪ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺠﺎﺩﺓ ﺃﻭ ﻭﺳﺎﺩﺓ ﻣﺜﻼ ﹰ.
ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺰﻳﺪ ﺳﺨﻮﻧﺔ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻞ ﻛﺜﻴﺮﺍ ﹰ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻷﻧﻪ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺃﻥ ﻳﻬﺒﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻳﺴﻘﻂ ﻷﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺴﺒﺐ
ﺗﻐﻄﻴﺔ ﻓﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻮﻳﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻋﺎﻗﺘﻬﺎ ﺃﻭ ﺳﺪﻫﺎ ،ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻹﺻﺎﺑﺔ ﺑﺠﺮﻭﺡ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺿﺮﺍﺭ.
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ. (٣ﻻ ﺗﻘﻒ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﺼﻌﺪ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ.
ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺳﺨﺎﻥ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﺿﻮﺀ (٧ • ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﺜﻘﻴﻒ ﺍﻷﻃﻔﺎﻝ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻣﺨﺎﻃﺮ ﺗﺴﻠﻖ ﺍﻷﺛﺎﺙ ﻟﻐﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ
ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﻟﻤﺒﺎﺷﺮ. ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ.
ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﺴﻄﺢ ﺍﻟﻜﺎﺑﻴﻨﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺬﻭﺏ ﻣﺘﺴﺒﺒﺎ ﹰ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﻛﻦ ﺣﺮﻳﺼﺎ ﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺟﻪ ﺍﻟﺨﺼﻮﺹ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺯﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺑﻬﺎ
ﺃﻭ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ. ﺃﻃﻔﺎﻝ ﻭﺍﻣﻨﻌﻬﻢ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻌﻮﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ .ﺇﺫ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﺤﺮﻙ
ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﺗﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺔ (٨ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﺃﻭ ﻳﻘﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ،ﺃﻭ ﻳﻠﺤﻖ ﺑﻪ ﺗﻠﻒ ،ﺃﻭ ﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ
ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺮﻃﻮﺑﺔ ،ﻛﺄﻥ ﺗﻀﻌﻪ ﻓﻲ ﻏﺮﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﺤﻤﺎﻡ ،ﺃﻭ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺇﺻﺎﺑﺔ ﺟﺴﺪﻳﺔ.
ﻟﻠﺘﺮﻃﻴﺐ.
ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﻧﺸﻮﺏ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ
ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺟﻮﺍﺭ ﻣﻮﻗﺪ ﺣﻴﺚ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻌﺮﺽ (٩
ﻟﻠﺰﻳﺖ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﺎﻥ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺒﺨﺎﺭ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﻀﻌﻪ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻓﻴﻪ
ﻛﻤﻴﺎﺕ ﻛﺒﻴﺮﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻐﺒﺎﺭ.
ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﻧﺸﻮﺏ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ
ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
٤
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
(٥ﻻ ﺗﺸﺪ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻧﺰﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﻣﻦ (١٠ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻬﺎﺕ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﻃﻴﺔ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻣﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ. • ﻋﻨﺪ ﻧﻘﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﺍﺣﺮﺹ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻧﺰﻉ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺄﺧﺬ
ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ﹰ ﺍﻣﺴﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺑﺲ ﺑﺈﺣﻜﺎﻡ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻧﺰﻋﻪ .ﺇﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺳﺤﺐ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ، ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺠﺪﺍﺭ ،ﻭﺍﻓﺼﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ،ﻭﻛﺎﺑﻼﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ /
ﻓﻘﺪ ﻳﺘﻠﻒ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﻚ ﻭﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﻧﺸﻮﺏ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ،ﻭﺃﻱ ﺷﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺛﺎﺑﺘﺔ ﻭﻣﺴﻤﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺜﺒﻴﺖ .ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﻠﻒ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ
ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ. ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ،ﻗﺪ ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ
(٦ﻻ ﺗﻘﻄﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﻚ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻹﻃﻼﻕ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﻘﺼﻪ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻟﻪ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﻘﻮﻡ ﺑﻠﻴﻪ ،ﺃﻭ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
ﺛﻨﻴﻪ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺸﺪﻩ ﺑﻘﻮﺓ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻼﺯﻡ. • ﻟﺤﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﻳﻠﺰﻡ ﺷﺨﺼﻴﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﻗﻞ ﻟﻠﻘﻴﺎﻡ ﺑﺬﻟﻚ .ﻭﺗﺄﻛﺪ
ﻻ ﺗﻀﻊ ﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﺛﻘﻴﻠﺔ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ ﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺘﺮﻛﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺣﻤﻠﻪ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻋﻤﻮﺩﻱ.
ﻳﺴﺨﻦ ﺃﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻼﺯﻡ ،ﺣﻴﺚ ﺇﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺗﻠﻒ ،ﺃﻭ • ﻻ ﺗﺤﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻭﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﻷﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻭ ﻷﺳﻔﻞ.
ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ .ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﻔﻨﻲ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺗﻠﻒ (١١ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻬﺎﺕ ﺍﺣﺘﻴﺎﻃﻴﺔ ﺣﻮﻝ ﺗﺮﻛﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ
ﺑﺴﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ. ﻳﺠﺐ ﹼﺃﻻ ﻻﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻮﻗﻊ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻄﻮﻁ
(٧ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻭﺟﻮﺩ ﺑﺮﻕ ﺃﻭ ﺭﻋﺪ ،ﻻ ﺗﻠﻤﺲ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺃﻱ ﻛﺎﺑﻼﺕ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﻟﻴﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺿﻮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ ﺃﻭ ﺩﻭﺍﺋﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ
ﻣﻮﺻﻠﺔ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ ﹰ. ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
ﺇﺫ ﺇﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﺪ ﻳﻌﺮﺿﻚ ﻟﺼﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ. ﺇﺫﺍ ﺳﻘﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻫﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻬﻮﺍﺋﻲ ،ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺒﺐ ﺇﺻﺎﺑﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ
ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻧﺔ
ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ
ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﻻ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺑﺘﺼﻠﻴﺢ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺗﻔﻜﻴﻚ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﻨﻔﺴﻚ. (١
ﻗﺪ ﻳﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻧﺪﻻﻉ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ. ﻻ ﺗﻘﻢ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﺎ ﹰ ﺑﻮﺿﻊ ﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﺳﺎﺧﻨﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺼﺎﺩﺭ ﻟﻬﺐ ﻣﻔﺘﻮﺡ، (١
ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺍﻹﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺑﻔﻨﻰ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻧﺔ ﻷﻏﺮﺍﺽ ﺍﻟﻔﺤﺺ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺼﻠﻴﺤﺎﺕ. ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﻀﻲﺀ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﺎﺑﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﻠﻴﻠﻴﺔ ،ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺃﻭ
ﺑﺎﻟﻘﺮﺏ ﻣﻨﻪ.
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺃﻱ ﻋﻄﻞ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ،ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺻﺪﻭﺭ ﺃﻱ ﺩﺧﺎﻥ (٢ ﺇﺫ ﺇﻥ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺗﻔﻌﺔ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺬﻳﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻼﺳﺘﻴﻚ ﻭﺃﻥ ﺗﺆﺩﻱ
ﺃﻭ ﺭﺍﺋﺤﺔ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻋﺎﺩﻳﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ،ﺃﻭﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺣﺮﺍﺋﻖ.
ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺭ ،ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻝ.
ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﺎﻥ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺮﺍﺋﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺒﻌﺜﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ،ﻭﺑﻌﺪﻫﺎ ﻳﺠﺐ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﺾ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺗﻨﺎﺛﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺴﺎﻗﻂ ﻗﻄﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺎﺀ (٢
ﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﻔﻨﻲ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ .ﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﻭﻳﺠﺐ ﻋﺪﻡ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺃﻳﺔ ﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﻣﻤﻠﻮﺀﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﺴﻮﺍﺋﻞ ،ﻣﺜﻞ ﺁﻧﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺰﻫﻮﺭ،
ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻟﺔ ،ﻓﺈﻥ ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ. ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ.
ﻋﻨﺪ ﺳﻘﻮﻁ ﺍﻟﺴﻮﺍﺋﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﻴﺮﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﻳﻤﻜﻦ
ﺇﺫﺍ ﺣﺪﺙ ﻭﺳﻘﻂ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻷﺭﺽ ،ﺃﻭ ﻛﺴﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺪﻭﻕ (٣ ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻤﻞ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺴﺒﺐ ﺍﻧﺪﻻﻉ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻭﻱ ﻟﻠﺠﻬﺎﺯ ،ﻓﺄﻭﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺭ ،ﻭﺃﺧﺮﺝ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺳﻘﻂ ﺟﺴﻢ ﺻﻐﻴﺮ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﻓﺄﻭﻗﻒ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻝ. ﻓﻮﺭﹰﺍ ﻭﺍﻧﺰﻉ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﻔﻨﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻧﺔ.
ﺇﺫﺍ ﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻟﻠﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻭﻫﻮ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻟﺔ،ﻓﺈﻥ
ﺫﻟﻚ ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﺴﺒﺐ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ .ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻻ ﺗﺪﺧﻞ ﺃﻱ ﺃﺷﻴﺎﺀ )ﻣﻌﺪﻧﻴﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻭﺭﻗﻴﺔ( ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻹﻃﻼﻕ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﺼﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﺎﺀ (٣
ﻛﺴﺮ ﺻﻨﺪﻭﻕ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ،ﻛﻦ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺣﺬﺭ ﻭﺃﻧﺖ ﺗﺘﻌﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﻓﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻮﻳﺔ ﻭﺃﻱ ﻓﺘﺤﺎﺕ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ.
ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺃﻱ ﺇﺻﺎﺑﺔ ﺟﺴﺪﻳﺔ. ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺍﺩ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺗﺴﺒﺐ ﻧﺸﻮﺏ ﺣﺮﻳﻖ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺪﻭﺙ ﺻﺪﻣﺔ
ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺑﺎﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺑﻔﻨﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﺪﻣﺔ ﻟﻔﺤﺺ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻭﺇﺻﻼﺣﻪ. ﻛﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻴﺔ .ﺇﺫﺍ ﺩﺧﻠﺖ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻷﺷﻴﺎﺀ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﻓﻮﺭﺍ ﹰ ﺃﻭﻗﻒ
ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﺍﻧﺰﻉ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺍﺗﺼﻞ ﺑﻔﻨﻲ
ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﺼﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻧﻬﺎﻳﺔ ﻋﻤﺮﻩ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻔﺎﺩﺓ (٤ ﺍﻟﺼﻴﺎﻧﺔ .ﺍﺣﺮﺹ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻋﺪﻡ ﻗﻴﺎﻡ ﺍﻷﻃﻔﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺼﻐﺎﺭ ﺑﺈﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻣﻮﺍﺩ ﺇﻟﻰ
ﻣﻨﻪ ﺧﻼﻟﻪ ،ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻌﻬﺪ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻓﻨﻲ ﺻﻴﺎﻧﺔ ﻣﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﺨﻠﺺ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺐ.
ﻋﻨﺪ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻟﻔﺘﺮﺓ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺰﻣﻦ ،ﻛﻤﺎ ﻳﺤﺪﺙ (٤
ﺃﻳﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻌﻄﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺴﻔﺮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻄﻮﻳﻠﺔ ،ﺍﻧﺰﻉ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﺍﻟﻘﺪﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺄﺧﺬ
ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻭﺫﻟﻚ ﻷﻏﺮﺍﺽ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ.
• ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺑﻴﻦ ﻳﺪﻳﻚ ﻻ ﻳﹸﻔﺼﻞ ﺗﻤﺎﻣﺎ ﹰ ﻣﻦ ﻣﺼﺪﺭ
ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻲ ،ﺇﺫ ﺃﻧﻪ ﻳﺴﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﻛﻤﻴﺔ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ
ﺍﻟﻜﻬﺮﺑﺎﺋﻲ ﺣﺘﻰ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ 1ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ
ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ.
• ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻗﺎﺑﺲ ﻣﺼﺪﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﻗﺎﺭﻥ ﻟﻴﻜﻮﻥ
ﺑﻤﺜﺎﺑﺔ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﻓﺼﻞ ،ﻭﺑﻨﺎﺀ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻓﺈﻥ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻔﺼﻞ ﻳﻈﻞ ﺟﺎﻫﺰﺍ ﹰ
ﻟﻠﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ﹰ.
٥
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
٦
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
ﺇﺳﺘﺜﻨﺎﺀﺍﺕ
ﺇﻥ Toshibaﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺆﻭﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺗﻌﻮﻳﺾ ﺍﻱ ﺗﻠﻒ ﻳﺤﺪﺙ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﺔ •
ﺍﻧﺪﻻﻉ ﺍﻟﻨﻴﺮﺍﻥ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻮﺍﺭﺙ ﺍﻟﻄﺒﻴﻌﻴﺔ )ﻣﺜﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﺎﻋﻘﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺰﻻﺯﻝ… ،
ﺍﻟﺦ( ،ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺛﺎﻟﺚ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺤﻮﺍﺩﺙ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺿﻴﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﺳﻮﺀ
ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﺎﻟﻚ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻟﻪ ﻓﻲ ﻇﺮﻭﻑ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻼﺋﻤﺔ.
ﺇﻥ Toshibaﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺆﻭﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺗﻌﻮﻳﺾ ﺍﻻﺿﺮﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﺭﺋﺔ )ﻣﺜﻞ ﺧﺴﺮﺍﻥ •
ﺍﻟﺮﺑﺢ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻧﻘﻄﺎﻉ ﺍﻷﻋﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ
ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻠﺔ… ،ﺍﻟﺦ( ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺤﺪﺙ ﻧﺘﻴﺠﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻘﺼﻮﺭ ﻓﻲ
ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ.
ﺇﻥ Toshibaﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺆﻭﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻱ ﺿﺮﺭ ﻧﺎﺗﺞ ﻋﻦ ﺇﻫﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ •
ﺍﻟﻮﺍﺭﺩﺓ ﻓﻲ ﻛﺘﻴﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﺎﻟﻚ.
ﺇﻥ Toshibaﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺴﺆﻭﻟﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺃﻱ ﺿﺮﺭ ﻧﺎﺗﺞ ﻋﻦ ﺳﻮﺀ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ •
ﺃﻭ ﻗﺼﻮﺭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻻﺩﺍﺀ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺗﺰﺍﻣﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﻭﺍﻷﺟﻬﺰﺓ
ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺻﻠﺔ.
٧
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
IN
OUT
ﺗﻨﺒﻴﻪ:
• ﺗﺨﻠﺺ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻓﻲ ﻣﻨﻄﻘﺔ ﻣﺨﺼﺼﺔ ﻟﻠﺘﺨﻠﺺ ﻣﻦ
ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ .ﻳﺠﺐ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﺾ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻟﻠﺤﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﺪﻳﺪﺓ ﻣﺜﻞ
ﺃﺷﻌﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﻤﺲ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﺭﺓ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻨﺎﺭ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺎ ﺷﺎﺑﻪ ﺫﻟﻚ.
• ﻭﻳﻨﺒﻐﻲ ﻣﺮﺍﻋﺎﺓ ﺍﻟﺠﻮﺍﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺌﻴﺔ ﺑﺸﺄﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻠﺺ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ.
• ﻳﹸﻤﻨﻊ ﹰ
ﻣﻨﻌﺎ ﺑﺎﺗﹰﺎ ﺧﻠﻂ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺧﻠﻂ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻌﻤﻠﺔ
ﻣﻊ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺓ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
• ﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺑﻄﺮﻳﻘﺔ ﺻﺤﻴﺤﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺻﺒﺢ
ﻣﺪﻯ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﺼﻴﺮﹰﺍ ،ﻓﺎﺳﺘﺒﺪﻝ ﻛﻠﺘﺎ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺘﻴﻦ ﺑﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺘﻴﻦ
ﺟﺪﻳﺪﺗﻴﻦ.
ﺗﻤﺎﻣﺎ ﺃﻭ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ
ﹰ • ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻓﺎﺭﻏﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺤﻨﺔ
ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﺳﺘﻈﻞ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻔﺘﺮﺓ ﺯﻣﻨﻴﺔ ﻃﻮﻳﻠﺔ ،ﻓﺄﺧﺮﺝ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ
ﻣﻨﻬﺎ ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﺣﻤﺾ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺮﺏ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺩﺍﺧﻞ ﺣﺠﻴﺮﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﻄﺎﺭﻳﺔ.
ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻯ ﺍﻟﻔﻌﺎﻝ
٨
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
) o HDMI 2ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻓﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺪﺧﻞ( −ﻳﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻭﺍﺟﻬﺔ ٦ ﻣﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻠﻔﺎﺯ
ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻋﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﺪﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ • ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﺴﺘﺨﺪﻣﺎ ﹰ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ
ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻀﻐﻮﻁ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ) HDMIﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٠ ﺍﻟﺠﺎﻧﺒﻴﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ .ﺣﺘﻮﻱ ﺍﻟﺠﺎﻧﺐ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻲ ﻣﻦ
ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻓﻴﺔ ﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺁﺧﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
) ”ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ“ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺎﺕ .(٤٦ –٢٩
• ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﺘﻌﻠﻖ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻛﻞ ﻣﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺗﺤﻜﻢ ،ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺎﺕ ﺑﻴﻦ
ﺍﻷﻗﻮﺍﺱ.
LAN
)(2
VIDEO
VIDEO
PC/HDMI 1 Y
)(AUDIO
L/
PB/CB MONO
PR/CR AUDIO
RGB/PC
R
L/
MONO
DIGITAL
AUDIO AUDIO
R
COMPONENT/
VIDEO INPUT )AUDIO(FIXED
)(1
٩
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
) o RGB/PC ١٤ﻃﺮﻑ ﺩﺧﻞ( −ﻟﻼﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻛﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ) o HDMI 1 ١٢ﺍﻟﻨﻬﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻟﻄﺮﻓﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﺪﺧﻞ( −ﻳﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺩﺧﻞ ﻭﺍﺟﻬﺔ
ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣١ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ )) (PC ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻋﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﺪﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﻭﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ
) (AUDIO) o PC/HDMI 1 ١٥ﻃﺮﻑ ﺍﺩﺧﺎﻝ( −ﻳﺸﺘﺮﻙ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺍﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻀﻐﻮﻁ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ) HDMIﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٠
ﺻﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﻣﻊ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺍﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻨﺎﻇﺮﻱ ،HDMIﻭﻳﻤﻜﻦ ) O DIGITAL AUDIO ١٣ﺑﺼﺮﻱ( )ﻃﺮﻑ ﺧﺮﺝ( −ﹸﻣﻌﺪ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ
ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﻬﻤﺎ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻼﺕ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣١ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻠﻪ ﺑﻤﻜﺒﺮ ﺻﻮﺕ ﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﻤﻨﻔﺬ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺻﻮﺕ ﺭﻗﻤﻲ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻨﻮﻉ
ﺍﻟﺒﺼﺮﻱ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٢٩
١٠
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
١١
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ) PINﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ( • ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺷﺒﻜﺔ ﻣﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ،ﺻﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ LAN
) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ (٣٥ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٣
• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ،ﻭﺻﻞ ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ
١ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ .PIN ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ TOSHIBA
٢ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺀ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺢ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK )ﻣﻮﺩﻳﻞ :WLM-40Uﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺮﻓﻖ( ﺑﻤﻨﻔﺬ ) USBﺻﻔﺤﺔ (٣٤
• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻻ ،ﺍﻧﻘﻞ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ .٩
٣ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ،ﺛﻢ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ. ٦
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﺃﻭ ﻻﺳﻠﻜﻲ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺗﺤﻘﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﻭ /ﺃﻭ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ MACﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ
ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ ،ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ.
٤ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﺭﻣﺰ ،PINﻗﻢ ﺑﺈﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻣﺰ PIN
ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺮﻭﺽ ﻓﻲ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ،ﻭﻣﻦ ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻲ
ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ ﻓﻲ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ .PINﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﺗﺸﻴﺮ ﺇﻟﻰ
ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ (٣٦ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻋﺪ ) ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ
١ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ،TOSHIBAﻻ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﻭﻳﺘﻢ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ﺍﻻﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ .٧
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ: ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺳﻠﻜﻲ:
ﺗﺤﻘﻖ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ MACﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ
ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ ،ﻭﺣﺪﺩ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻘﺪﻡ.
ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ .٧
٢ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﺋ ﹴﺬ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ. ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻻﺳﻠﻜﻲ:
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ.
٣ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ
) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩
ﻟﺤﻔﻆ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
• ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻠﺘﺰﻡ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺮﻭﻁ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ:
:TKIP/AES ،AES -ﻣﻦ 8ﺇﻟﻰ ASCII 63ﺃﻭ 64ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ
ﺳﺪﺍﺳﻴﺎ
ﹰ
-ﺍﻟﺨﺼﻮﺻﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﺎﻓﺌﺔ ﻟﻠﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﻜﻴﺔ ):(WEP ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ
ﺳﺪﺍﺳﻴﺎ 5ﺃﻭ ASCII 13ﺃﻭ 10ﺃﻭ 26ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻋﺪ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺪﻭﻱ ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﹰ
• ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﹸﻣﻌﺮﱢﻑ ﺭﺋﻴﺴﻲ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻟﻀﺒﻄﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ )ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺑﺰﺭ ﺿﻐﻂ(
ﺗﺸﻔﻴﺮ .WEP ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ (٣٥
٤ﺣﺪﺩ ﺗﻤﺖ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ١ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ .PBC
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﻓﺮﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺗﻴﻦ ٤ﻭ ٥ﻓﻲ ٢ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺪﺀ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺢ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺪﻭﻱ ﺃﺩﻧﺎﻩ ﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺿﻐﻂ ﺗﻤﺖ. ٣ﺍﺗﺒﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ،ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺐ
ﻟﻨﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ.
٤ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﺗﺸﻴﺮ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ
.OK
١٢
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻘﺪﻡ ،ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ٧ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ (٣٦ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺪﻭﻱ )
ﺇﻟﻰ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ،ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻲ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻲ.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ١
ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ DHCPﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺟﻴﻪ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ .OK
ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ،ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﺋ ﹴﺬ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ.
ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ) .ﻳﺠﺐ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺫﻟﻚ ﹰ
ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ
ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ(. ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ٢
ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩
ﻟﺤﻔﻆ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٣
ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﺘﺮﻙ ﺃﻭ
WPA2/WPA-PSKﺃﻭ .WPA2-PSK
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٤
ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺃﻭ WEPﺃﻭ AESﺃﻭ .AES/TKIP
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
• ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻣﻊ
ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺗﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﺔ.
-ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ،ﻻ ﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ
ﺳﻮﻯ WEPﻭﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻓﻘﻂ.
-ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﺘﺮﻙ،
ﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ WEPﻭﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ.
ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ DHCPﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺟﻴﻪ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ -ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ،WPA2/WPA-PSKﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ
ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ،ﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﻭﺍﺿﺒﻂ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ AESﺃﻭ .AES/TKIP
IP Addressﻟﻌﻨﻮﺍﻥ )ﻋﻨﺎﻭﻳﻦ( DNSﻳﺪﻭﻳﹰﺎ. -ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ،WPA2-PSKﻻ ﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ
ﺳﻮﻯ .AES
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ،OKﻭﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺒﺪﺃ ﻓﺤﺺ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ. ٨ • ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﹸﻣﻌﺮﱢﻑ ﺭﺋﻴﺴﻲ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻟﻀﺒﻄﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ
ﺳﺘﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﺋ ﹴﺬ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ ﻟﻺﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻧﺠﺎﺡ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺃﻭ ﺗﻌﺬﺭ ﺗﺸﻔﻴﺮ .WEP
ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻟﻪ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٥
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ: ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ٦
ﺩﺍﺋﻤﺎ.
ﻻ ﺗﻀﻤﻦ ﻧﺘﺎﺋﺞ ﻓﺤﺺ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﹰ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٩ ﻟﺤﻔﻆ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ.
ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ. ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺼﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﺩﻱ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ
ﻋﻠﻰ ﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ.
ﺣﺪﺩ ﺗﻤﺖ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٧
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ ،ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ .ﺍﺿﻐﻂ
ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻌﻢ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺣﺪﺩ ﺑﺪﺀ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺢ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ OKﻟﺒﺪﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ. ١٠
١٣
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
.Gﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺳﻴﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﻪ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ،ﹸ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻟﻠﺒﺤﺚ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺃﻭ ﻟﻠﺒﺤﺚ ﺃﺳﻔﻠﻪ. ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺎ.
ﹰ ﻳﺪﻭﻳﺔ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻣﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻋﻤﻠﻴﺔ ﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﻪ ﻳﺪﻭﻳﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﻌﺬﺭ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺒﻖ
ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ. ﻟﻠﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺇﺫﺍ ﺃﺭﺩﺕ ﺿﺒﻂ
ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﺜﻮﺭ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺤﻄﺔ ،ﺳﻴﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺿﻬﺎ. ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﻣﺴﺒﻘﹰ ﺎ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﻣﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﻣﻌﻴﻨﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﺗﻠﻮ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ.
ﻻ ﺗﻀﻐﻂ ﺃﺑﺪﺍ ﹰ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻱ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﺃﺛﻨﺎﺀ ﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ.
.Hﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﻳﺪﻭﻳﺔ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﻟﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ
ﻭﺻﻮﺕ.
.Iﻣﻘﻮﻱ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ
ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻟﻬﺎ ﺿﻌﻴﻔﺔ /ﻗﻮﻳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ
ﻣﺸﻮﺷﺔ ،ﻓﻴﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﺤﺴﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ
ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﻘﻮﻱ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ
ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻠﻪ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻭ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺮﻳﺪ ﺗﺮﺗﻴﺒﻪ، ١١
.Jﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ OKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﻨﻴﻒ.
ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻄﺎﺕ ﺗﺤﺖ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﻓﻲ ﻛﻞ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻋﻨﺼﺮ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ
ﻣﺮﺓ ﺗﺸﻐﻞ ﻓﻴﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻗﻨﺎﺓ ﻣﺎ ،ﺃﻭ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ . ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺼﺮ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻣﻮﺿﺢ ﺃﺩﻧﺎﻩ.
ﻟﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻧﺸﺎﺀ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻄﺎﺕ:
(١ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻣﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺣﺮﻑ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﺍﻍ
ﺍﻷﻭﻝ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ .
١٤
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
ﺗﻌﻠﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ
ﺇﻧﻨﺎ ﻧﻘﺘﺮﺡ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺍﻻﻃﻼﻉ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺨﻄﻄﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﺋﻢ:
• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ MENUﻋﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻋﻨﺎﻭﻳﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﺋﻢ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ.
• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻋﻨﺼﺮ.
• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺃﻭ ﺿﺒﻄﻪ.
• ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ.
ﻋﺮﺽ ﻣﺨﻄﻂ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﺋﻢ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
• ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ) o1ﻭ o2ﻭ ،(HDMIﻻ ﺗﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﺍﻟﺨﻴﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﻭﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﻪ ﻳﺪﻭﻳﺔ ﻭﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺳﺮﻳﻌﺔ.
ﺍﻭﺗﻮﻣﺎﺗﻴﻜﻴﺎ.
ﹰ • ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺑﺎﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻟﻤﺪﺓ ﻗﺼﻴﺮﺓ ،ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﺨﺘﻔﻲ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ
• ﺇﺫﺍ ﺭﻏﺒﺖ ﻓﻲ ﺇﻏﻼﻕ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻘﻮﺍﺋﻢ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻔﻮﺭ ،ﻓﺎﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ EXITﺃﻭ .MENU
• ﻟﻠﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .BACK
• ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ،ﺗﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ PCﻓﻲ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٢
• ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﺴﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺇﺩﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ،(٢٠ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻷﺳﺎﺳﻴﺔ.
• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ”ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ﻣﻦ ) “TOSHIBAﻣﻮﺩﻳﻞ :WLM-40Uﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺮﻓﻖ( ،ﺗﻈﻬﺮ Screen Mirroringﻓﻲ
ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻄﺒﻴﻘﺎﺕ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٤٠
١٥
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺗﺨﺘﻠﻒ ﻋﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻌﺔ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺤﺎﻟﻲ.
ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ١ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .٢٢ ﻣﻘﻮﻱ ﺟﻬﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ
ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ. ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .١٤ ﻣﻘﻮﻱ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ
ﻟﻠﻤﻮﺍﺿﻊ ﺍﻷﻗﻞ ﻣﻦ ،١٠ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ٠ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ،ﻋﻠﻰ ﺳﺒﻴﻞ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .٤٣ ﺍﻟﻮﻗﺖ ﺍﻟﻔﺎﺻﻞ
ﺍﻟﻤﺜﺎﻝ ،ﻟﻠﻤﻮﺿﻊ .١ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .٤٢ Device Information
٢ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﹰ
ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺿﻊ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ PUﺃﻭ .Pu ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .١٨ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ
ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺿﻊ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﻣﻊ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﺣﺎﺩﻱ / ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .٢١ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ
ﺍﻻﺳﺘﺮﻳﻮ /ﺍﻟﻤﺰﺩﻭﺝ. ﺻﻔﺤﺎﺕ .٤٦ ،٤٤ ﺍﻋﺎﺩﺓ
١٦
ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺪﻣﺔ /ﺍﻟﺒﺪﺀ
١٧
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ PC ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺻﻞ ﻋﺒﺮ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ HDMI • ﺗﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﻣﻌﻈﻢ ﻋﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻭﻭﻇﺎﺋﻔﻬﺎ .ﺇﻻ ﺃﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺍﺕ
ﺃﻭ RGB/PCﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ ﺗﻨﺴﻴﻖ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻛﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ .ﻳﻌﺮﺽ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻟﻦ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﺘﺎﺣﺔ ﺳﺘﺄﺧﺬ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﺩﻱ.
ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺳﻠﻴﻢ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺺ.
ﺍﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺣﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺣﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ١
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺣﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺐ )ﺃﻭ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ
ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﻣﺘﻜﺮﺭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺣﺠﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﻣﺒﺎﺷﺮﺓ(.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ) OKﻣﻮﺍﻓﻖ(. ٢
ﻋﺮﻳﺾ PC
ﻋﺮﻳﺾ
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﻊ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺻﻞ ﻋﺒﺮ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ HDMI
ﺃﻭ RGB/PCﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ ﺗﻨﺴﻴﻖ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻛﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ .ﺳﻴﻌﺮﺽ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺘﻬﻴﺌﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﺳﻄﻮﺍﻧﺔ DVDﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ
ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺃﻱ ﺗﺸﻮﻩ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺺ ﺟﺰﺀ ﻣﻨﻬﺎ. ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ ،ﺃﻭ ﺷﺮﻳﻂ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺑﻨﺴﺒﺔ ﺃﺑﻌﺎﺩ
) 16:9ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﻓﺮﻩ( .ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﻀﺔ ) 16:9ﺃﻭ 14:9ﺃﻭ … 20:9ﺍﻟﺦ( ،ﻗﺪ ﺗﺸﺎﻫﺪ
ﺧﻄﻮﻁ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺃﺳﻔﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ.
ﻓﺎﺋﻖ ﺍﻟﺤﻴﻮﻳﺔ
ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺗﻜﺒﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﻨﺴﺒﺔ 4:3ﻟﺘﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﻣﻦ
ﻋﺎﺩﻱ ﻭﺭﺃﺳﻴﺎ ،ﻣﻤﺎ ﻳﺤﻘﻖ ﺗﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﻓﻲ ﻣﺮﻛﺰ
ﹰ ﺃﻓﻘﻴﺎ
ﹰ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺗﻤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ
ﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺎﺱ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻣﻞﺀ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻷﺑﻌﺎﺩ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ .ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﺤﺪﺙ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ.
ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻓﻴﻠﻢ ﻣﺨﺰﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ .USB
ﺃﺻﻠﻲ
ﺯﻭﻡ ﻳﻌﺮﺽ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺳﻠﻴﻢ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﺃﻭ ﻗﺺ.
ﻳﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﻘﺎﺱ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻣﻞﺀ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﻧﺴﺒﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﺪﺍﺭﺓ 21:9ﻋﻨﺪ
ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﻓﻴﻠﻢ ﻣﺨﺰﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ .USB
١٨
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ،ﺛﻢ ١
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
١٩
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ MPEGﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻟﻬﺎ ﺻﻮﺕ ﺑﻌﻮﺿﺔ )ﻣﺘﻘﻄﻌﺔ( ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ،Detail Booster ١
ﺍﻋﺘﻤﺎﺩﹰﺍ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺤﻮﻳﻞ ،ﻭﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺿﻌﻴﻔﺔ ﻭﺑﺎﻫﺘﺔ ،ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺗﺤﺴﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﻴﺔ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻌﺰﱢﺯ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻳﻖ. ٢
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺨﻔﻴﻒ ١ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ. ٣
ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎﺀ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺩﻗﺔ ﻓﺎﺋﻘﺔ. ٤
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ. ٥
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺴﻴﻨﻤﺎ
ﺗﻘﻠﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺗﻤﻮﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺍﻟﺘﻘﻠﻴﻞ ﻣﻦ ﺳﻄﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺃﻭ
ﺍﺧﺘﺮ ،Auto Clean 2ﻭﻣﻦ ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ٢ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﺔ ﻭﻣﻴﺾ.
ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ.
ﻭﺿﻊ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ:
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻭﺿﻊ ١
ﺍﻟﺴﻴﻨﻤﺎ.
ﺗﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺘﺎ MPEGﻟﺘﺨﻔﻴﺾ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎﺀ ﻭﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺗﺨﻔﻴﺾ
ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻴﻜﻲ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ. ٢
• ﻭﺿﻊ MPEGﻟﺘﺨﻔﻴﺾ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎﺀ :ﻣﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ﺃﻭ
ﻋﺎﻟﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ
• ﻭﺿﻊ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺗﺨﻔﻴﺾ ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻴﻜﻲ )ﺗﺨﻔﻴﺾ
ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺯﻳﺎﺩﺓ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺓ ﺃﻭ ﺑﺮﻭﺩﺓ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ
ﺍﻟﻀﻮﺿﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ( :ﻣﻨﺨﻔﺾ ﺃﻭ ﻣﺘﻮﺳﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻋﺎﻟﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ
ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺩﺭﺟﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻷﺣﻤﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﻕ.
ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺩﺭﺟﺔ ﺣﺮﺍﺭﺓ ١
ﺗﻌﻴﺪ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻊ. ﺍﻟﻠﻮﻥ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ: ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﺎﺭﺩ ﺃﻭ ﻃﺒﻴﻌﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺩﺍﻓﺊ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺐ. ٢
ﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ،ﻓﻠﻦ ﻳﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﺍﻟﺨﻴﺎﺭ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ.
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﻩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ، ١
ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﺋ ﹴﺬ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﺄﻛﻴﺪ .ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻌﻢ ،ﺛﻢ ٢
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺿﺒﻂ ﺇﺩﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ
ﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻷﺣﻤﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ ٣
ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﺃﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺑﺎﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺳﺘﺔ ﺃﻭﺿﺎﻉ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﻕ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺣﺴﺐ
ﻟﻠﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻲ :ﺃﺣﻤﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺧﻀﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺻﻔﺮ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺣﻤﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﻠﺐ.
ﺃﺭﺟﻮﺍﻧﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺯﺭﻕ ﻣﺨﻀﺮ ﹼ.
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺇﺩﺍﺭﺓ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ .3D ١
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ. ٢
٢٠
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺿﺒﻂ ﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﻌﺪﻳﻞ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻷﺳﺎﺳﻴﺔ. ٣
ﺿﺒﻂ ) MTSﺻﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ(
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ،OKﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ٤
ﺿﺒﻄﻪ.
ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ
ﻳﻘﻮﻡ ﻭﺿﻊ MTSﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻌﺮﻑ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﺮﺍﻣﺞ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﺮﻳﻮ/ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻠﻐﺔ
ﺗﺒﻌﺎ ﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺒﺚ.
ﺑﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺔ ﹰ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ،MENUﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ. ١
٢١
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٢٢
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻭﺻﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٢ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺗﺤﻜﻢ ﻓﻲ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ
ﻳﻤﻨﻊ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻪ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ.
ȝǾƬƱƓȚ
ǀƳƃƪŽȚǓƃǤ
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺤﻜﻢ ﻓﻲ ﺗﺸﻮﻳﻪ ١
ǠǣƾƲƴů ǁƉƳƄƸƴƸů
ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ.
1 ǁƉƳƄƸƴƸƄŽȚǀưŽ
ȯƾƲƁȘ ǀŲǞƴŽȚȲƾƱŻȚ
ȩǍƯŽȚǀŵƾŵȝȚȢȚNjŸȘ
ȴǞƁǎƱƴƄŽȚǀƴǧȶ
ǀŻƾƭŽȚǍƸźǞůȝȚȢȚNjŸȘ
ǚƸưƪů ȔƾŻȤǎŽȚǀŵƾƪŽȚ
٢٣
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٢٤
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ: ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
• ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻲ ﻫﻮ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ. ﻻ ﺗﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﻤﻂ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ.
• ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ.
ﺍﻗﻔﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ
ﻋﺮﺽ ﺗﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ
ﻳﺆﺩﻱ”ﺍﻗﻔﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ“ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺗﻌﻄﻴﻞ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ .ﺇﻻ ﺃﻧﻪ
ﺗﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ﻟﻴﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺿﻬﺎ ﻻ ﺗﺰﺍﻝ ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺇﻣﻜﺎﻧﻴﺔ ﻻﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ.
ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ.
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻼﺕ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻗﻔﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ. ١
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ. ١ ٢ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ) OKﻣﻮﺍﻓﻖ(. ٢ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﺟﻤﻴﻊ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺧﻴﺺ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻗﻔﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ،ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﺬﻛﻴﺮ ﻋﻨﺪ ﻟﻤﺲ
ﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ. ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ .ﺇﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺿﻐﻂ ﻣﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ،
ﻳﺘﻢ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺇﺧﺮﺍﺟﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﻌﻤﺎﻝ
ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻘﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺻﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ ﻓﻘﻂ.
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ، ١ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺗﻮﻗﻒ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ﻟﻠﺘﻴﺎﺭ
ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺎ )ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ( ﺑﻌﺪ ﺣﻮﺍﻟﻲ ٤ﺳﺎﻋﺎﺕ، ﺳﻴﺘﻢ ﺇﻏﻼﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﹰ
٢ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺇﺻﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ. ﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﻘﻢ ﺑﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﹸﻌﺪ ﺃﻭ ﻟﻮﺡ
ﺗﺤﻜﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺍﺻﺪﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺮﻭﺽ ﻫﻮ ﻟﻠﺘﻮﺿﻴﺢ ﻓﻘﻂ. ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻼﺕ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺪ ١
ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺗﻮﻓﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٢ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﻮﻗﻒ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ﻟﻠﺘﻴﺎﺭ ،ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ
ﺇﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺟﻤﻴﻊ ﺍﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ، ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .EXIT
ﺑﻤﺎ ﻓﻲ ﺫﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺰﻧﺔ ،ﻋﻠﻰ ﻗﻴﻤﻬﺎ ﺍﻷﺻﻠﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﻨﻊ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻋﺎﺩﺓ ﺿﺒﻂ ١ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﺳﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﺤﺬﻳﺮ ،ﻗﺒﻞ ﺍﻻﻧﺘﻘﺎﻝ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﺑﺪﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ.
ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ
ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺎ ﺑﻌﺪ ١٥ﺩﻗﻴﻘﺔ ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺍﻛﺘﺸﺎﻑ
ﹰ ﺳﻴﺘﻢ ﺇﻏﻼﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ .ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﻟﻸﻏﺮﺍﺽ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ:
• ﻗﻮﺓ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻣﻨﺨﻔﻀﺔ ﻟﻘﻨﺎﺓ ﺗﻨﺎﻇﺮﻳﺔ )ﻟﻢ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﻛﺘﺸﺎﻑ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ(.
• ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻨﻔﺬ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻷﻳﻤﻦ/ﺍﻷﻳﺴﺮ ﺑﺪﺧﻞ ﺧﺎﺭﺟﻲ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻤﺎﻉ ﺇﻟﻰ
ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ ﻋﺒﺮ ﺳﻤﺎﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺗﻮﻓﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ١
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻻ ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﻟﺘﻮﻗﻒ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﺎﺭ ،ﺛﻢ ٢
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻼﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ. ٢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺼﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮﻩ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٣
ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ.
ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﻣﺤﺬﺭﺓ ﻣﻦ ﺃﻥ ﺟﻤﻴﻊ ﺍﻻﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻔﻘﺪ.
ﺣﺪﺩ ﻧﻌﻢ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻠﻤﺘﺎﺑﻌﺔ.
ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺑﺎﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ،ﺳﺘﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﻰ
) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(١١ﺇﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﻠﻤﺘﺎﺑﻌﺔ ،ﻭﺍﺳﺘﻤﺮ ﺣﺘﻰ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ
ﺇﻟﻰ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﻣﻮﺍﻟﻔﺔ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺔ.
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺭﻣﺰ PINﻟﻠﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ PIN
) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩
٢٥
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺒﻨﺪ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺩ ﺗﺴﻤﻴﺘﻪ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٣ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ) OKﻣﻮﺍﻓﻖ(. ٢
ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ --ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﻀﺨﻢ ﺃﻭ ﻛﺒﻞ ﺃﻭ DVDﺃﻭ ﺃﻟﻌﺎﺏ ﺃﻭ PCﺃﻭ ،COMPONENT/VIDEO INPUT ،o (1)) VIDEO 1ﺃﻭ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ
ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺠﻞ ﺃﻭ ﺳﺘﺎﻻﻳﺖ ﺃﻭ ،VCRﺃﻭ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺃﺣﻤﺮ ﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻗﻴﺎﺳﻲ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻣﻜﻮﻥ(،
ﺍﻟﺘﺨﻄﻲ. ،o (2)) VIDEO 2ﺃﻭ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻗﻴﺎﺳﻲ(،
ﻛﺮﺭ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ ٣ﻟﺪﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻵﺧﺮ. ٤ ) HDMI2 ،HDMI1ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ،(HDMI
،RGB/PC o) PCﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ (PC
ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .LISTﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻻﺋﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ. ١ )ﻣﺮﻛ ﱠﺐ(.
ﺗﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻣﻨﺎﻓﺬ ﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﻘﻴﺎﺳﻲ ﹸ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ،MENUﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ. ١
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٢
ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ﺃﻭ PALﺃﻭ SECAMﺃﻭ NTSC4.43ﺃﻭ .NTSC3.58
٣ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﺘﺨﺰﻳﻦ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻷﻟﻮﺍﻥ ﻋﻠﻰ ”ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ“ .ﺇﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﻳﻜﻦ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﻛﺬﻟﻚ،
ﻓﺤﺪﺩ ”ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ“ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺃﻭ .
٢٦
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻗﻠﻴﻠﺔ.
• ﻳﺠﺐ ﺍﻟﺨﺮﻭﺝ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ ﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ.
ﺍﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻜﺴﺖ FASTEXTﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ،ﺗﺮﻯ ٤ﻋﻨﺎﻭﻳﻦ ﻣﻠﻮﻧﺔ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﻋﺎﻣﺔ ﻋﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ
ﺑﺄﺳﻔﻞ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ .ﻟﻔﺘﺢ ﺃﻱ ﻣﻮﺿﻊ ،ﻣﺎ ﻋﻠﻴﻚ ﺳﻮﻯ ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ
ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻨﻲ ﻓﻲ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ. ﺍﻟﺰﺭ :TEXT
ﺍﺫﺍ ﻟﻢ ﺗﻜﻦ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ﻓﺎﺳﺘﻜﺴﺖ FASTEXTﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ ،ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺃﻱ
ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ﺑﻤﺠﺮﺩ ﺍﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ٣ﺧﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﻀﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ TEXTﻣﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﺣﺪﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻇﻬﻮﺭ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ.
ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﻇﺮ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻹﺿﺎﻓﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺗﺄﺗﻲ ﻓﻲ ﺑﺚ ﻋﺎﺩﻱ.
ﻟﻤﺰﻳﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺣﻮﻝ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ )ﺃﻧﻈﻤﺔ( ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺪﺩﺓ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺎﺣﺔ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻟﻠﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻱ .ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﻨﺖ ﺗﺮﻳﺪ
ﻟﺪﻳﻚ ،ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ﻓﻬﺮﺱ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﻤﺤﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺚ ﺃﻭ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻘﻨﻮﺍﺕ ،ﻻ ﺑﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻳﺔ.
ﺍﺳﺘﺸﺮ ﻣﻮﺯﻉ Toshibaﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻲ. ﻭﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﻐﻂ TEXTﻷﻭﻝ ﻣﺮﺓ ﻟﻠﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺨﺪﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﻨﺼﻴﺔ ،ﺳﺘﻜﻮﻥ
ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺮﺍﻫﺎ ﻫﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺘﺎﺣﻴﺔ.
ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ،ﻳﺆﺩﻱ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺿﻮﻋﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻮﻓﺮﺓ
ﻭﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﺻﻔﺤﺎﺗﻬﺎ.
ﺣﺎﻟﻴﺎ ﻓﻲ ﻛﻞ ﺯﺭ
ﹰ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻊ ﻻﺋﺤﺔ ،ﺳﺘﻈﻬﺮ ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺰﻧﺔ
ﻣﻠﻮﻥ.
٢٧
ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺼﺎﺋﺺ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
21:56:25
ﻭﻣﻴﻀﺎ.
ﹰ ﺳﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻢ ﻭﻳﹸﺤﺪﺙ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ OKﻟﺘﺨﺰﻳﻦ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ. ٤
ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺻﻔﺤﺎﺕ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﺑﺒﺴﺎﻃﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺧﻼﻝ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻗﻢ ﻣﻜﻮﻥ ٥
ﻣﻦ ٣ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ ،ﻟﻜﻦ ﺗﺠﻨﺐ ﻣﻄﻠﻘﹰ ﺎ ﺿﻐﻂ ،OKﻭﺇﻻ ﻓﺴﻮﻑ ﺗﻔﻘﺪ
ﺟﻤﻴﻊ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻠﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺨﺰﻧﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﻌﻞ.
ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ
ﻓﻴﻤﺎ ﻳﻠﻲ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺑﺄﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﻮﺩﺓ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ
ﺑﻌﺪ ﻟﺪﻳﻚ ﻭﻭﻇﺎﺋﻔﻬﺎ.
ﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ﺗﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ:
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ TEXTﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ .ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻹﺿﺎﻓﺔ
ﺍﻟﺘﻴﻠﻴﺘﻜﺴﺖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺻﻮﺭﺓ ﺗﺄﺗﻲ ﻓﻲ ﺑﺚ ﻋﺎﺩﻱ .ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ﻟﻠﻌﻮﺩﺓ
ﺇﻟﻰ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻌﺎﺩﻱ.
ﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ﻓﻬﺮﺱ/ﺍﻓﺘﺘﺎﺣﻴﺔ:
ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ
ﻟﻠﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﻬﺮﺱ .ﻳﻌﺘﻤﺪ ﺍﻟﻔﻬﺮﺱ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺮﻭﺽ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ
ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﺤﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ.
ﻓﻲ ﻭﺿﻊ ﻻﺋﺤﺔ
ﻟﻠﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ ١٠٠ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻷﻭﻟﻴﺔ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ
٢٨
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻧﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻼﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﻠﻔﻴﺔ
ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻤﺘﺎﻉ ﺑﺪﻳﻨﺎﻣﻴﻜﻴﺔ ﺻﻮﺕ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺠﻮﺩﺓ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ
ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ. ﻣﺜﺎﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺗﻮﺻﻞ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺧﺮﺝ DIGITAL AUDIOﺑﻤﻨﻔﺬ ﺩﺧﻞ AC-3 RFﻓﻲ • ﻻ ﱢ
ﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ Dolby Digital Receiverﻣﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﺪﻳﻜﻮﺩﺭ Dolby Digital
ﹺ ﹸﻣ )(2
VIDEO
ﻣﻀﻤﻦ. Y
VIDEO
ﺴﺘﻘﺒﻞ ﺃﻭ ﻣﻌﺎﻟﺞ.
ﹺ ﹸﻣ
• ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺩﻟﻴﻞ ﻣﺎﻟﻚ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ PR/CR AUDIO
ﺃﻳﻀﺎ.
ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺻﻞ ﹰ
ﱠ
• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺑﺄﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ ،ﺗﺄﻛﺪ ﻣﻦ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻭﻓﺼﻞ
R
L/
MONO
VIDEO VIDEO
Y Y
PB/CB PB/CB
PR/CR PR/CR
L/ L/
MONO MONO
٢٩
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
• :HDMIﻭﺍﺟﻬﺔ ﻭﺳﺎﺋﻂ ﻣﺘﻌﺪﺩﺓ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺪﻗﺔ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻤﻀﺨﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺰﻭﺩ ﺑﺪﺧﻞ ﺻﻮﺗﻲ ﺭﻗﻤﻲ )ﺑﺼﺮﻱ(
• :HDCPﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﺫﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺩﺩﻱ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﻳﺾ
• ﻳﺸﻤﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻣﻊ CEA-861-Dﺑﺚ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻀﻐﻮﻁ
ﻣﻊ ﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﻋﺮﻳﻀﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﺟﺔ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﻟﻠﻤﺤﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ،ﻭﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﻳﺘﻢ
ﻗﻴﺎﺳﻴﺎ ﻻﺳﺘﻘﺒﺎﻝ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ .ﻭﻧﻈﺮﺍ ﹰ ﹰ ﺗﻮﺣﻴﺪﻫﺎ
ﻷﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺗﻜﻨﻮﻟﻮﺟﻴﺎ ﻧﺎﺷﺌﺔ ﻭﻣﺘﻄﻮﺭﺓ ،ﻓﻤﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻤﻜﻦ ﺃﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ
ﺍﻷﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﻜﻞ ﺍﻟﺼﺤﻴﺢ ﻣﻊ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
• ﺗﻨﺴﻴﻖ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻼﺋﻤﺔ:
• VESA :S-VGAﺑﺪﻗﺔ ٦٠٠ 5 ٨٠٠ﻋﻨﺪ ٧٥/٧٢/٦٠/٥٦ﻫﺮﺗﺰ
• VESA :XGAﺑﺪﻗﺔ ٧٦٨ 5 ١٠٢٤ﻋﻨﺪ ٧٥/٧٠/٦٠ﻫﺮﺗﺰ
• VESA :W-XGAﺑﺪﻗﺔ ٧٦٨ 5 ١٢٨٠ﻋﻨﺪ ٧٥/٦٠ﻫﺮﺗﺰ DIGITAL
• VESA :W-XGAﺑﺪﻗﺔ ٧٦٨ 5 ١٣٦٠ﻋﻨﺪ ٦٠ﻫﺮﺗﺰ AUDIO
OUT
ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﻀﻐﻮﻁ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ HDMIﻭ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻲ ﻏﻴﺮ
ﺍﻟﻤﻀﻐﻮﻁ ﻣﻦ ﺟﻬﺎﺯ .DVI
ﺻﻤﻢ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺪﺧﻞ ﻟﻘﺒﻮﻝ ﻣﺎﺩﺓ ﺑﺮﻧﺎﻣﺞ HDCPﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭﺓ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﻤﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ
ﺇﻟﻜﺘﺮﻭﻧﻴﺔ ﻳﺴﺘﺨﺪﻣﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻬﻠﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﺘﻮﺍﻓﻘﺔ ﻣﻊ ) CEA-861-Dﻣﺜﻞ
ﺍﻟﺼﻨﺪﻭﻕ ﺍﻟﻌﻠﻮﻱ ﻟﻠﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﻭﻣﺸﻐﻞ DVDﻣﻊ ﺧﺮﺝ HDMIﻭ .(DVI
ﹸﺻﻤﻢ ﺩﺧﻞ HDMIﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺃﻓﻀﻞ ﺃﺩﺍﺀ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻋﺎﻟﻴﺔ
ﺍﻟﻮﺿﻮﺡ ﺑﺪﻗﺔ ) 1080iﺑﺘﺮﺩﺩ ٦٠/٥٠ﻫﺮﺗﺰ( ﻭ) 1080pﺑﺘﺮﺩﺩ ٦٠/٥٠/٢٤ﻫﺮﺗﺰ(،
ﺃﻳﻀﺎ ﻋﺮﺽ ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ 480iﻭ 480pﻭ 576iﻭ 576pﻭ) 720pﺑﺘﺮﺩﺩ ﻟﻜﻨﻪ ﻳﻘﺒﻞ ﹰ
٦٠/٥٠ﻫﺮﺗﺰ( ﻭﺇﺷﺎﺭﺍﺕ ) VGAﻣﻦ ﻧﻮﻉ VESAﺑﺪﻗﺔ ٤٨٠ × ٦٤٠ﻋﻨﺪ
٧٥/٧٢/٦٠ﻫﺮﺗﺰ(.
٣٠
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ
ﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺣﺎﺳﺐ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﺑﻤﺪﺧﻞ RGB/PCﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﻴﺰﻳﻮﻥ:
ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻛﺎﺑﻞ ﻛﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ RGBﻗﻴﺎﺳﻲ ) ١٥ﺩﺑﻮﺱ(.
PC/HDMI 1
)(AUDIO
RGB/PC DVI
VIDEO AUDIO
L R OUT
IN
OUT
٣١
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺨﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺩ ﺿﺒﻄﻪ .ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٣
ﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺣﺴﺐ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ. ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
• ﻗﺪ ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﺣﻮﺍﻑ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺭ ﻣﺨﺘﻔﻴﺔ.
• ﺇﺫﺍ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ ﻣﻮﺩﻳﻼﺕ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﺫﻭﺍﺕ
ﺇﺷﺎﺭﺓ ﺧﺎﺻﺔ ،ﻓﻘﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺍﻛﺘﺸﺎﻓﻬﺎ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ.
٣٢
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٣٣
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٣٤
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ
ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ،ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ .PBC ٤
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺳﻠﻜﻲ ،ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ”ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻘﺪﻡ“ ٣
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﺑﺪﺀ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺢ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٥ ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٧ )
ﺍﺗﺒﻊ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﻠﻴﻤﺎﺕ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ،ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺎﺳﺐ ﻟﻨﻘﻄﺔ ٦ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ
ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﺗﺸﻴﺮ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٧ • ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ
ﻻﻟﻐﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ: ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻮﺻﻞ.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ BACKﺃﺛﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ .ﺳﻴﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﺧﻄﺎﺭ ،ﻭﻣﻦ ﺛﻢ • ﺗﻜﻮﻥ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﺩﻱ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﻌﻢ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ﺳﻠﻜﻲ.
• ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ
ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ) PINﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ( ﺃﻭ ﻧﺰﻋﻪ ،ﻳﺠﺐ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﻭﻧﺰﻉ ﺳﻠﻚ ﺍﻟﻄﺎﻗﺔ ،ﺛﻢ
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻠﻪ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﻣﺮﺓ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ.
ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻼﺕ ،ﺣﺪﺩ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ١ • ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺘﻤﺮ ﺑﻨﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ) (APﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﻀﻤﻮﻥ .ﻗﺪ ﻳﻔﺼﻞ ﻫﺬﺍ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٢ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺃﺛﻨﺎﺀ ﻣﺸﺎﻫﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ.
• ﻻ ﺗﻨﺰﻉ ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٣ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﻧﻮﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻻﺳﻠﻜﻲ ﺃﻭ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﻳﻜﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻼﺗﺼﺎﻝ
ﻧﺸﻄﺎ.
ﹰ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ .PIN ٤
ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ٣ﻃﺮﻕ ﻟﻺﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ:
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺑﺪﺀ ﺍﻟﻤﺴﺢ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٥
ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ ) PBCﺃﻭ (PIN
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ٦ ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻧﺖ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺗﺪﻋﻢ ،WPSﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻻﺳﻠﻮﺏ.
.OK • ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻴﺎﺭ WPSﻫﻮ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭ ﺻﻨﺎﻋﻲ ﻣﺼﻤﻢ ﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ: ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﻭﺣﻤﺎﻳﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ .ﺳﻴﻘﻮﻡ WPSﺑﺘﻜﻮﻳﻦ
ﺗﺤﻘﻖ ﻣﻦ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﻭ /ﺃﻭ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ MACﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺗﻠﻘﺎﺋﻴﺎ ﹰ.
ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ ،ﻭﺍﺧﺘﺮ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ. ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺭﺑﻤﺎ ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﻜﻮﻳﻦ ﺗﺸﻔﻴﺮ WEPﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﺴﻬﻞ.
٣٥
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺪﻭﻱ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﺭﻣﺰ ،PINﻗﻢ ﺑﺈﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻣﺰ PINﺍﻟﻤﻌﺮﻭﺽ ﻓﻲ ٧
ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ،ﻭﻣﻦ ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻲ ﻟﻼﺳﺘﻤﺮﺍﺭ ﻓﻲ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ .PIN
ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻼﺕ ،ﺣﺪﺩ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ١ ﻋﻨﺪﻣﺎ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﺗﺸﻴﺮ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻛﺘﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٢ ﻻﻟﻐﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ:
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ BACKﺃﺛﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ .ﺳﻴﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﺧﻄﺎﺭ ،ﻭﻣﻦ ﺛﻢ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻳﺪﻭﻱ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٣ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻻﺧﺘﻴﺎﺭ ﻧﻌﻢ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٤ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻋﺪ
ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﺋ ﹴﺬ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ.
ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻼﺕ ،ﺣﺪﺩ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ١
ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﺍﺳﻢ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ٥
) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻲ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٢
ﻟﺤﻔﻆ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﻕ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻣﺴﺎﻋﺪ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٣
ﺇﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ٦ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺑﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ٤
ﻓﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﺘﺮﻙ ﺃﻭ WPA2/WPA-PSKﺃﻭ .OK
.WPA2-PSK ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺇﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﻭﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ٧ ﺗﺤﻘﻖ ﻣﻦ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ MACﻋﻠﻰ ﺑﻄﺎﻗﺔ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺪﻟﻴﻞ،
ﻭﺣﺪﺩ ﻧﻘﻄﺔ ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻮﻝ.
ﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ ﺃﻭ WEPﺃﻭ AESﺃﻭ .AES/TKIP
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ: ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٥
• ﻫﻨﺎﻙ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻣﻊ ﺃﻧﻮﺍﻉ ﺗﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻨﺪﺋ ﹴﺬ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ.
ﻣﻌﻴﻨﺔ.
-ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻓﺘﺢ ﺍﻟﻨﻈﺎﻡ ،ﻻ ﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺳﻮﻯ WEP ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ٦
ﻭﻻ ﺷﻲﺀ ﻓﻘﻂ. ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩
-ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺘﺎﺡ ﺍﻟﻤﺸﺘﺮﻙ ،ﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ WEPﻭﻻ
ﺷﻲﺀ. ﻟﺤﻔﻆ ﺍﻹﻋﺪﺍﺩ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﻕ.
-ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ،WPA2/WPA-PSKﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ AESﺃﻭ ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
.AES/TKIP • ﻳﺠﺐ ﺃﻥ ﺗﻠﺘﺰﻡ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﻟﺸﺮﻭﻁ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ:
-ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺛﻴﻖ ﻋﻠﻰ ،WPA2-PSKﻻ ﻳﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺳﻮﻯ .AES ) TKIP -ﺑﺮﻭﺗﻮﻛﻮﻝ ﺗﻜﺎﻣﻞ ﻣﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﻗﺘﺔ(
• ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﹸﻣﻌﺮﱢﻑ ﺭﺋﻴﺴﻲ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻟﻀﺒﻄﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺸﻔﻴﺮ ) AES/ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻔﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﻘﺪﻡ( :ﻣﻦ 8ﺇﻟﻰ 63 ASCIIﺃﻭ 64
.WEP ﺳﺪﺍﺳﻴﺎ
ﹰ ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ
-ﺍﻟﺨﺼﻮﺻﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﺎﻓﺌﺔ ﻟﻠﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﻠﻜﻴﺔ ) 5 :(WEPﺃﻭ 13
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٨ ﺳﺪﺍﺳﻴﺎ
ﹰ ASCIIﺃﻭ 10ﺃﻭ 26ﺣﺮﻓﹰﺎ
ﺃﺩﺧﻞ ﻛﻠﻤﺔ ﺍﻷﻣﺎﻥ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ٩ • ﻳﻮﺟﺪ ﹸﻣﻌﺮﱢﻑ ﺭﺋﻴﺴﻲ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﻓﻘﻂ ﻟﻀﺒﻄﻪ ﻣﻦ ﺃﺟﻞ ﺗﺸﻔﻴﺮ
) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩ .WEP
٣٦
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﺣﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ. ٤ ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ IPﻟﻠﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ IP Address
ﻗﻴﻤﺔ ﻗﻨﺎﻉ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻴﺔ Subnet Mask
ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ ﺍﻟﺒﻮﺍﺑﺔ ﺍﻻﻓﺘﺮﺍﺿﻴﺔ ﺑﻮﺍﺑﺔ ﻣﺒﺪﺋﻴﺔ
ﻋﻨﻮﺍﻥ DNS DNS
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺳﺘﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﻌﻨﺎﺻﺮ ﺍﻷﺧﺮﻯ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﺩﻱ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﻀﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻘﺎﺋﻲ
ﻋﻠﻰ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ.
٣٧
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٣٨
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ .ﺳﺘﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ EXITﺃﺛﻨﺎﺀ ﺍﻟﺒﺤﺚ ﻋﻦ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺍﻹﻧﺘﺮﻧﺖ. ١
ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﻐﻂ OKﻓﻲ ﺣﻘﻞ ﻳﻘﺒﻞ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺣﺮﻭﻑ.
ﻹﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻧﺺ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ: ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻗﻔﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ
• ﺗﺘﻮﻓﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﻋﻨﺪ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻟﻠﺸﺒﻜﺔ
ﺣﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ ﻓﻲ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻌﺮﻭﺿﺔ ١ ﻓﻲ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ) ﺻﻔﺤﺔ .(٣٩
ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ. • ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﻣﻴﺰﺓ ﻗﻔﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ﻟﻤﻨﻊ ﻭﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ.
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﻋﻠﻰ ) OKﻣﻮﺍﻓﻖ(. ٢ • ﺳﺘﻈﻬﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺓ ﺑﺎﻟﻠﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺎﺩﻱ ﺣﺘﻰ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ
ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ.
ﻛﺮﺭ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺗﻴﻦ ١ﻭ ٢ﺇﻟﻰ ﺃﻥ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻛﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﺍﻟﻤﻄﻠﻮﺏ. ٣
ﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﻀﻼﺕ ،ﺣﺪﺩ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ١
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﻕ ﻹﻏﻼﻕ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﻌﻮﺩﺓ ﺇﻟﻰ ٤
ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺎﺑﻘﺔ. ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻗﻔﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ٢
ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ.
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺿﻐﻂ ،BACKﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺣﻔﻆ ﺍﻟﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻭﻳﺘﻢ ﺇﻏﻼﻕ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﻹﻟﻐﺎﺀ ﻗﻔﻞ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ:
ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ .ﻭﺳﻴﻈﻞ ﺍﻟﻨﺺ ﻛﻤﺎ ﻫﻮ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺑﺪﺀ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ.
ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻹﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻣﻦ ﻭﺣﺪﺓ ﺍﻟﺘﺤﻜﻢ ﻋﻦ ﺑﻌﺪ:
ﺣﺪﺩ ﺇﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ ٢ﺃﻋﻼﻩ. ١
ﺍﻟﻮﺻﻒ ﺍﻟﺰﺭ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻟﻠﺸﺒﻜﺔ
ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﻑ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺪﺩ. OK
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺿﺒﻂ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ،OKﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ١
ﻧﻘﻞ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﻑ. ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻟﻠﺸﺒﻜﺔ.
ﺣﺬﻑ ﺣﺮﻑ ﻭﺍﺣﺪ ﺇﻟﻰ ﻳﺴﺎﺭ ﺍﻟﻤﺆﺷﺮ. ﺍﻷﺣﻤﺮ ٢ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ،OKﺛﻢ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﻹﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻋﺪﺩ ﻣﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ٤
ﺍﻟﺘﻨﻘﻞ ﺑﻴﻦ ﺍﻟﺤﺮﻭﻑ ﺍﻟﻜﺒﻴﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻟﺼﻐﻴﺮﺓ ﻭﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﺍﻷﺧﻀﺮ ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ .ﺛﻢ ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﺄﻛﻴﺪ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ.
ﻭﺍﻟﺮﻣﻮﺯ ،ﺇﺫﺍ ﻛﺎﻥ ﻣﺘﻮﻓﺮﹰﺍ. ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺣﻔﻆ ﺍﻟﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ ﻭﺇﻏﻼﻕ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻷﺯﺭﻕ ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ “.“٠٠٠٠
ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ. ﻟﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺬﻓﻪ:
ﺇﻏﻼﻕ ﻧﺎﻓﺬﺓ ﻟﻮﺣﺔ ﺍﻟﻤﻔﺎﺗﻴﺢ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﻣﺠﻴﺔ ﺩﻭﻥ ﺣﻔﻆ BACK
ﺍﻟﺘﻐﻴﻴﺮﺍﺕ. ﻓﻲ ﻗﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺇﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺗﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻟﻠﺸﺒﻜﺔ ،ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﻡ ﺃﺯﺭﺍﺭ ١
ﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﻹﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﺍﻟﻤﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ ٤ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ.
ﺣﺪﺩ ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺣﺬﻑ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ٢
ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﺗﻐﻴﻴﺮ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺍﺯﺭﺍﺭ ﺍﻷﺭﻗﺎﻡ ﻻﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﺭﻗﻢ ﺟﺪﻳﺪ ﻣﻜﻮﻥ ٤ﺃﺭﻗﺎﻡ.
ﺣﺬﻑ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﻧﻌﻢ ،ﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺗﻌﻴﻴﻦ ﺭﻣﺰ ﺍﻟﺘﻌﺮﻳﻒ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﻋﻠﻰ “.“٠٠٠٠
٣٩
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
• ﺑﺪﻻ ﹰ ﻣﻦ ﺫﻟﻚ ،ﺍﺿﻐﻂ QUICKﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻌﺔ ﻭﻗﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ،YouTubeﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٢
ﺑﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪﻫﺎ.
ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺍﻟﺼﻔﺤﺔ ﺍﻟﺮﺋﻴﺴﻴﺔ ﻟﻤﻮﻗﻊ .YouTube
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﻣﻬﺎﻳﺊ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﻠﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﻼﺳﻠﻜﻴﺔ ﺛﻨﺎﺋﻲ • ﻳﻤﻜﻨﻚ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺪ YouTubeﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﻘﺎﺋﻤﺔ ﺍﻟﺴﺮﻳﻌﺔ.
ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻗﺎﺕ ) :WLM-40Uﻏﻴﺮ ﻣﺮﻓﻖ( ،ﻻ ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﻋﺮﺽ .Screen Mirroring ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ:
ﺍﺿﻐﻂ ﺃﻭ ﻟﺘﺤﺪﻳﺪ ،Screen Mirroringﺛﻢ ﺍﺿﻐﻂ .OK ٢ • ﺗﺘﻄﻠﺐ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻤﻴﺰﺍﺕ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ﺇﻧﺘﺮﻧﺖ ﻋﺮﻳﺾ ﺍﻟﻨﻄﺎﻕ ﺩﺍﺋﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ،
ﻣﺨﺼﺼﺎ ﻟﻬﺬﺍ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﻴﺎ ﻭﺗﺤﺪﻳﺚ ﺍﻟﺒﺮﺍﻣﺞ ﺍﻟﺜﺎﺑﺘﺔ ،ﻭ/ﺃﻭ ﻋﺮﺽ ﻧﻄﺎﻕ
ﹰ ﹰ
ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﻌﺪﺍﺩ ﻟﻠﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ. ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ .ﻗﺪ ﺗﺘﻐﻴﺮ ﺧﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺛﺎﻟﺚ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺘﻌﺮﺽ ﻟﻺﻳﻘﺎﻑ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺤﻈﺮ
ﻗﻢ ﺑﺘﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﺗﻒ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ٣ ﻓﻲ ﺃﻱ ﻭﻗﺖ .ﻻ ﺗﻘﺪﱢﻡ Toshibaﺃﻱ ﺿﻤﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺘﺰﺍﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﻭ ﺗﺄﻛﻴﺪﺍﺕ
ﺑﺸﺄﻥ ﻣﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﺃﻃﺮﺍﻑ ﺛﺎﻟﺜﺔ ﺃﻭ ﺧﺪﻣﺎﺗﻬﺎ ﺃﻭ ﺗﻮﻓﺮﻫﺎ ﺃﻭ ﺃﺩﺍﺋﻬﺎ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﻲ.
ﻟﻌﺮﺽ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ. ﻭﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﻄﻠﺐ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺧﺪﻣﺎﺕ ﻃﺮﻑ ﺛﺎﻟﺚ ﺍﻟﺘﺴﺠﻴﻞ ﺑﺎﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ
ﺣﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﺗﺮﻏﺐ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺘﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺑﻪ. ﻛﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﻭ/ﺃﻭ ﺩﻓﻊ ﺭﺳﻮﻡ ﻭﻋﻀﻮﻳﺔ .ﻭﻳﺠﻮﺯ ﻋﺪﻡ ﺗﻮﻓﺮ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﺨﺪﻣﺎﺕ
ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﺘﻢ ﻋﺮﺽ ”ﺟﺎﺭﻱ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ“ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ. ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻳﺎﺕ ﻓﻲ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﺃﻭ ﻓﻲ ﺑﻠﺪﻙ ﺃﻭ ﺑﻠﻐﺘﻚ .ﻭﻟﻠﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ
• ﻭﺿﻊ :PBC ﻛﻞ ﺇﻣﻜﺎﻧﺎﺕ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ،ﻗﺪ ﻳﺘﻄﻠﺐ ﺍﻷﻣﺮ ﺗﻮﻓﻴﺮ ﺃﺟﻬﺰﺓ ﻣﺘﻮﺍﻓﻘﺔ
ﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﻛﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ،Screen Mirroringﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻜﺎﻣﻞ.
ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﺗﻒ • ﻳﺠﻮﺯ ﺣﻈﺮ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﺨﺪﻣﺔ ﺇﺟﺒﺎﺭﻳﹰﺎ ﻭﻓﻘﹰ ﺎ ﻟﻤﻮﻗﻒ ﺧﺪﻣﺔ ) CSPﺍﻟﺘﺤﺰﻳﻢ
ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ. ﺑﻤﻘﺎﺱ ﺍﻟﺮﻗﺎﻗﺔ(.
• ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﻫﺬﻩ ﺍﻟﻮﻇﻴﻔﺔ ﺑﺸﻜﻞ ﺻﺤﻴﺢ ﺗﺒﻌﺎ ﹰ ﻟﺒﻴﺌﺔ ﺍﻟﺸﺒﻜﺔ.
• ﻭﺿﻊ :PIN
ﺍﻧﺘﻘﻞ ﺇﻟﻰ ﺍﻟﺨﻄﻮﺓ .٤
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﺗﻒ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ٤
ﻷﻭﻝ ﻣﺮﺓ
ﻋﻨﺪ ﺗﺤﺪﻳﺪ ﺗﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ Toshibaﻷﻭﻝ ﻣﺮﺓ ،ﺳﻮﻑ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﺭﻣﺰ ﻣﻜﻮﻥ ﻣﻦ
٨ﺃﻋﺪﺍﺩ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ .ﻭﻳﺠﺐ ﺇﺩﺧﺎﻝ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﺮﻣﺰ ﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ
ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﺗﻒ ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻲ ﻟﻤﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ.
ﻓﻲ ﺣﺎﻟﺔ ﺇﺟﺮﺍﺀ ﺍﻟﻤﺼﺎﺩﻗﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻔﻌﻞ ،ﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻈﻬﺮ ”ﺟﺎﺭﻱ ﺍﻻﺗﺼﺎﻝ“
ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺸﺎﺷﺔ.
• ﺑﻌﺪ ﺇﻛﻤﺎﻝ ﺍﺗﺼﺎﻝ ،Screen Mirroringﺳﻮﻑ ﺗﻌﺮﺽ ﺷﺎﺷﺔ
ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ ﺍﻟﻤﺤﺘﻮﻯ ﺍﻟﺬﻱ ﻳﻈﻬﺮ ﻋﻠﻰ ﺍﻟﺠﻬﺎﺯ ﺍﻟﻠﻮﺣﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻬﺎﺗﻒ
ﺍﻟﺬﻛﻲ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﻜﻤﺒﻴﻮﺗﺮ.
٤٠
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٤١
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٤٢
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٤٣
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٤٤
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٤٥
ﺗﻮﺻﻴﻞ ﺍﻟﺘﻠﻴﻔﺰﻳﻮﻥ
٤٦
ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺟﻊ
ﺍﻟﻤﻠﺤﻖ
ﺗﻨﺴﻴﻘﺎﺕ ﻣﺸﻐﻞ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﻟﻤﺪﻋﻤﺔ
ﺗﻨﺴﻴﻖ ﻣﺸﻐﻞ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ/ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ ﺍﻣﺘﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ
ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ
ﺗﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﺍﻟﺒﻴﺎﻧﺎﺕ JPEG Exif :ﺇﺻﺪﺍﺭ ٢٫١ JPEG .jpg JPEG
ﺍﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ٤٠٩٦ :ﻣﺠﻠﺪ .jpeg
ﺍﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ٤٠٩٦ :ﻣﺠﻠﺪ )H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ( .avi AVI
ﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﻟﺪﻗﺔ ﺍﻟﻌﺮﺽ: DivX 3, 4, 5
١٠٨٠x١٩٢٠ Xvid
MJPEG
*( ﻗﺪ ﻻ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﺸﻐﻴﻞ ﺑﻌﺾ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ.
MPEG-1/2ﻃﺒﻘﺔ ٢ ﺻﻮﺗﻲ(
MPEG-1/2ﻃﺒﻘﺔ ٣
)Dolby Digital (AC-3
L-PCM
ADPCM
WMA7/8/9 Std
MPEG-1ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ( .mpg MPEG-2
ﻓﻴﻠﻢ
MPEG-2ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .mpeg PS
MPEG-1/2ﻃﺒﻘﺔ ٢ ﺻﻮﺗﻲ( .dat
MPEG-1/2ﻃﺒﻘﺔ ٣
)Dolby Digital (AC-3
L-PCM
MPEG-2ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ( .ts MPEG-2
)H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC .trp TS
)VC-1 (WMV9 .tp
MPEG-1/2ﻃﺒﻘﺔ ٢ ﺻﻮﺗﻲ( .m2ts
)Dolby Digital (AC-3
L-PCM
٤٧
ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺟﻊ
ﺗﻨﺴﻴﻖ ﻣﺸﻐﻞ
ﻣﻼﺣﻈﺔ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ/ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺍﻣﺘﺪﺍﺩ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻒ
ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ ﺍﻟﻮﺳﺎﺋﻂ
ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮMPEG-2 (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .vob MPEG-2
٢ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ VOB
Dolby Digital (AC-3)
L-PCM
H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC) (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .mov MOV
٢ ﺟﺰﺀMPEG-4
MJPEG
٣ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 Audio (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ
MPEG-2/4 LC AAC
H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC) (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .mp4 MP4
٣ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 Audio (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ .m4v
MPEG-2/4 LC AAC
٢ ﺟﺰﺀMPEG-4 (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .asf ASF
VC-1 (WMV9) .wmv
ADPCM (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ .xvid
WMA7/8/9 Std
DivX 5 (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .divx DivX
٣ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 Audio (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ .div
Dolby Digital (AC-3) ﻓﻴﻠﻢ
ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮMPEG-2 (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .mkv MKV
٢ ﺟﺰﺀMPEG-4 .xdiv
H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC)
Xvid
٢ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ
٣ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2
Dolby Digital (AC-3)
MPEG-2/4 LC AAC
RealVideo 8, 9, 10 (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .rm RealMedia
RA-COOK (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ .rmvb
Sorenson H.263 (FLV1) (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .flv Flash
H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC) Video
٣ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 Audio (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ (FLV1)
MPEG-2/4 LC AAC
٢ ﺟﺰﺀMPEG-4 (ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .3gp 3GPP
H.264 (MPEG-4 AVC)
MPEG-4 LC AAC (ﺻﻮﺗﻲ
ﻣﺠﻠﺪ٤٠٩٦ :ﺍﺍﻟﺤﺪ ﺍﻷﻗﺼﻰ ﻟﻌﺪﺩ ﺍﻟﻤﻠﻔﺎﺕ ٣ ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 .mp3 MP3
MPEG-2/4 LC AAC .mp4 MP4
.m4a
WMA7/8/9 Std .wma WMA
ﻣﻮﺳﻴﻘﻰ
L-PCM .wav WAV
ADPCM
٢- ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2 .mka MKA
٣- ﻃﺒﻘﺔMPEG-1/2
٤٨
ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺟﻊ
٤٩
ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺟﻊ
٥٠
ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺟﻊ
٥١
ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺟﻊ
٥٢
ﻗﺴﻢ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺍﺟﻊ
• ﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﺧﻴﺺ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﺑﻤﻮﺟﺐ ﺗﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺑﺮﺍﺀﺓ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺍﻉ MPEG-4 ﺍﻟﻤﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺨﺎﺻﺔ ﺑﺎﻟﻌﻼﻣﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ
VISUALﻟﻼﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﻭﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﻱ ﻣﻦ ﹺﻗﺒﻞ ﺃﻱ ﻣﺴﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﻣﺼﻄﻠﺤﺎﺕ HDMIﻭHDMI High-Definition Multimedia Interface •
ﺑﻐﺮﺽ ) (١ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻣﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻌﻴﺎﺭ MPEG-4 VISUAL ﻭﺷﻌﺎﺭ HDMIﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﺃﻭ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻣﺴﺠﻠﺔ ﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ
) STANDARD (MPEG-4 VIDEOﻭ/ﺃﻭ ) (٢ﻓﻚ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰﻩ HDMI Licensing LLCﻓﻲ ﺍﻟﻮﻻﻳﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺘﺤﺪﺓ ﻭﺑﻠﺪﺍﻥ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ.
ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﻣﺴﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ﺑﻨﺸﺎﻁ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ ﻭﻏﻴﺮ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻱ ﻭ/ﺃﻭ ﺗﻢ ﺗﻢ ﺍﻟﺘﺼﻨﻴﻊ ﺑﻤﻮﺟﺐ ﺗﺮﺧﻴﺺ ﻣﻦ ﺷﺮﻛﺔ .Dolby Laboratories •
ﺍﻟﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﻓﺮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻣﺮﺧﺺ ﻟﻪ ﺑﺘﻮﻓﻴﺮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ MPEG-4 ﻣﺴﺠﻠﺔ ﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ Dolby ﺗﹸﻌﺪ Dolbyﻭﺭﻣﺰ Dﺍﻟﻤﺰﺩﻭﺝ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ
ﹼ
VIDEOﻣﻦ .MPEG LAﻭﻻ ﺗﻤﺘﺪ ﺃﻱ ﹴﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺃﻭ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻀﻤﻴﻨﻬﺎ .Laboratories
ﻷﻳﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ .ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ ® DivXﻭ® DivX Certifiedﻭ DivX Plus® HDﻭﺍﻟﺸﻌﺎﺭﺍﺕ ﺍﻟﻤﺮﺗﺒﻄﺔ •
ﺑﺸﺄﻥ ﺍﻻﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﻭﻳﺠﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺪﺍﺧﻠﻴﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻭﺍﻟﺘﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﻣﻦ ﺑﻬﺎ ﻋﻼﻣﺎﺕ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻳﺔ ﻟﺸﺮﻛﺔ Rovi Corporationﺃﻭ ﺍﻟﺸﺮﻛﺎﺕ ﺍﻟﻔﺮﻋﻴﺔ
ﺷﺮﻛﺔ .MPEG LA، L.L.C ﺍﻟﺘﺎﺑﻌﺔ ﻟﻬﺎ ﻭﺗﺴﺘﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﻤﻮﺟﺐ ﺗﺮﺧﻴﺺ!
ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﻗﻊ HTTP://WWW. MPEGLA. COM ﻣﺸﻤﻮﻟﺔ ﺑﻮﺍﺣﺪ ﺃﻭ ﺍﻛﺜﺮ ﻣﻦ ﺑﺮﺍﺀﺍﺕ ﺍﻻﺧﺘﺮﺍﻉ ﺍﻻﻣﺮﻳﻜﻴﺔ ﺍﻟﺘﺎﻟﻴﺔ.
• This product contains technology subject to certain 7,295,673؛ 7,460,668؛ 7,515,710؛ 7,519,274
intellectual property rights of Microsoft. Use or distribution ﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﺧﻴﺺ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﺑﻤﻮﺟﺐ ﺗﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺑﺮﺍﺀﺓ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺍﻉ AVC •
of this technology outside of this product is prohibited ﻟﻼﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﻭﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﻱ ﻟﻠﻤﺴﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﺑﻐﺮﺽ ) (١ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ
without the appropriate license(s) from Microsoft. ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻌﺎﻳﻴﺮ ) AVCﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ (AVCﻭ /ﺃﻭ ) (٢ﻓﻚ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ
• This product includes technology owned by Microsoft ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ AVCﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰﻩ ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﻣﺴﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ﺑﻨﺸﺎﻁ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ
Corporation and can not be used or distributed without a ﻭﻏﻴﺮ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻱ ﻭ/ﺃﻭ ﺗﻢ ﺍﻟﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﻓﺮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻣﺮﺧﺺ ﻟﻪ
license from Microsoft Licensing, GP. ﺑﺘﻮﻓﻴﺮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .AVCﻭﻻ ﺗﻤﺘﺪ ﺃﻱ ﹴﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺃﻭ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻀﻤﻴﻨﻬﺎ
ﻷﻳﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ .ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ
ﺷﺮﻛﺔ .MPEG LA ،L.L.C
ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﻗﻊ HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM
ﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﺧﻴﺺ ،3 -MPEG Layerﻭﺍﻟﺘﻲ ﺗﻌﻤﻞ ﺑﺘﻜﻨﻮﻟﻮﺟﻴﺎ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ ﺍﻟﺼﻮﺕ، •
ﻣﻦ ﻗﺒﻞ ﺷﺮﻛﺘﻲ ،Fraunhofer LLSﻭ .Thomson
ﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﺧﻴﺺ ﻫﺬﺍ ﺍﻟﻤﻨﺘﺞ ﺑﻤﻮﺟﺐ ﺗﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺑﺮﺍﺀﺓ ﺍﺧﺘﺮﺍﻉ VC-1 •
ﻟﻼﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻡ ﺍﻟﺸﺨﺼﻲ ﻭﻏﻴﺮ ﺍﻟﺘﺠﺎﺭﻱ ﻟﻠﻤﺴﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﺑﻐﺮﺽ ) (١ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ
ﺍﻟﻔﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﺑﺎﻟﺘﻮﺍﻓﻖ ﻣﻊ ﻣﻌﺎﻳﻴﺮ ) VC-1ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ (VC-1ﻭ/ﺃﻭ ) (٢ﻓﻚ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰ
ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ VC-1ﺗﻢ ﺗﺮﻣﻴﺰﻩ ﺑﻮﺍﺳﻄﺔ ﻣﺴﺘﻬﻠﻚ ﻣﺮﺗﺒﻂ ﺑﻨﺸﺎﻁ ﺷﺨﺼﻲ
ﻭﻏﻴﺮ ﺗﺠﺎﺭﻱ ﻭ/ﺃﻭ ﺗﻢ ﺍﻟﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻴﻪ ﻣﻦ ﻣﻮﻓﺮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ ﻣﺮﺧﺺ ﻟﻪ
ﺑﺘﻮﻓﻴﺮ ﻓﻴﺪﻳﻮ .VC-1ﻭﻻ ﺗﻤﺘﺪ ﺃﻱ ﹴﻣﻦ ﺍﻟﺘﺮﺍﺧﻴﺺ ﺃﻭ ﻳﺘﻢ ﺗﻀﻤﻴﻨﻬﺎ
ﻷﻳﺔ ﺍﺳﺘﺨﺪﺍﻣﺎﺕ ﺃﺧﺮﻯ .ﻳﻤﻜﻦ ﺍﻟﺤﺼﻮﻝ ﻋﻠﻰ ﻣﻌﻠﻮﻣﺎﺕ ﺇﺿﺎﻓﻴﺔ ﻣﻦ
ﺷﺮﻛﺔ .MPEG LA ،L.L.C
ﺭﺍﺟﻊ ﺍﻟﻤﻮﻗﻊ HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM
٥٣
٥٤
٥٥